SemaOverload.cpp revision db762ef262987403b4e2a3bb8d5762277306a224
1//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===// 2// 3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4// 5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7// 8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9// 10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 11// 12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 15#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 17#include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 18#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 19#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 20#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 21#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 22#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 23#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 24#include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 27#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 28#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 29#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 30#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 31#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 32#include <algorithm> 33 34namespace clang { 35using namespace sema; 36 37/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a 38/// function. 39static ExprResult 40CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 42 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 43 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), 44 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 45 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 46 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 47 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE); 48 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take()); 49 if (E.isInvalid()) 50 return ExprError(); 51 return move(E); 52} 53 54static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 55 bool InOverloadResolution, 56 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 57 bool CStyle, 58 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 59 60static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 61 QualType &ToType, 62 bool InOverloadResolution, 63 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 64 bool CStyle); 65static OverloadingResult 66IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 67 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 68 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 69 bool AllowExplicit); 70 71 72static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 73CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 75 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 76 77static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 78CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 81 82static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 83CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 84 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 86 87 88 89/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion 90/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 91ImplicitConversionCategory 92GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 93 static const ImplicitConversionCategory 94 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 95 ICC_Identity, 96 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 97 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 98 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 99 ICC_Identity, 100 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment, 101 ICC_Promotion, 102 ICC_Promotion, 103 ICC_Promotion, 104 ICC_Conversion, 105 ICC_Conversion, 106 ICC_Conversion, 107 ICC_Conversion, 108 ICC_Conversion, 109 ICC_Conversion, 110 ICC_Conversion, 111 ICC_Conversion, 112 ICC_Conversion, 113 ICC_Conversion, 114 ICC_Conversion, 115 ICC_Conversion, 116 ICC_Conversion 117 }; 118 return Category[(int)Kind]; 119} 120 121/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 122/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 123ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 124 static const ImplicitConversionRank 125 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 126 ICR_Exact_Match, 127 ICR_Exact_Match, 128 ICR_Exact_Match, 129 ICR_Exact_Match, 130 ICR_Exact_Match, 131 ICR_Exact_Match, 132 ICR_Promotion, 133 ICR_Promotion, 134 ICR_Promotion, 135 ICR_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Conversion, 139 ICR_Conversion, 140 ICR_Conversion, 141 ICR_Conversion, 142 ICR_Conversion, 143 ICR_Conversion, 144 ICR_Conversion, 145 ICR_Conversion, 146 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 147 ICR_Conversion, 148 ICR_Conversion, 149 ICR_Writeback_Conversion 150 }; 151 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 152} 153 154/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 155/// implicit conversion. 156const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 157 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 158 "No conversion", 159 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 160 "Array-to-pointer", 161 "Function-to-pointer", 162 "Noreturn adjustment", 163 "Qualification", 164 "Integral promotion", 165 "Floating point promotion", 166 "Complex promotion", 167 "Integral conversion", 168 "Floating conversion", 169 "Complex conversion", 170 "Floating-integral conversion", 171 "Pointer conversion", 172 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 173 "Boolean conversion", 174 "Compatible-types conversion", 175 "Derived-to-base conversion", 176 "Vector conversion", 177 "Vector splat", 178 "Complex-real conversion", 179 "Block Pointer conversion", 180 "Transparent Union Conversion" 181 "Writeback conversion" 182 }; 183 return Name[Kind]; 184} 185 186/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 187/// sequence to the identity conversion. 188void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 189 First = ICK_Identity; 190 Second = ICK_Identity; 191 Third = ICK_Identity; 192 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 193 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 194 ReferenceBinding = false; 195 DirectBinding = false; 196 IsLvalueReference = true; 197 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 198 BindsToRvalue = false; 199 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 200 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 201 CopyConstructor = 0; 202} 203 204/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 205/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 206/// implicit conversions. 207ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 208 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 209 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 210 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 211 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 212 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 213 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 214 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 215 return Rank; 216} 217 218/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 219/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 220/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 221/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 222bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 223 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 224 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 225 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 226 // a pointer. 227 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 228 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 229 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 230 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 231 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 232 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 233 return true; 234 235 return false; 236} 237 238/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 239/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 240/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 241/// 13.3.3.2p4). 242bool 243StandardConversionSequence:: 244isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 245 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 246 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 247 248 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 249 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 250 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 251 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 252 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 253 254 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 255 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 256 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 257 258 return false; 259} 260 261/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 262/// or after one in an implicit conversion. 263static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) { 264 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 265 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 266 case CK_NoOp: 267 case CK_IntegralCast: 268 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 269 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 270 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 271 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 272 case CK_FloatingCast: 273 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 274 continue; 275 276 default: 277 return Converted; 278 } 279 } 280 281 return Converted; 282} 283 284/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 285/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 286/// 287/// \param Ctx The AST context. 288/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 289/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 290/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 291NarrowingKind 292StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx, 293 const Expr *Converted, 294 APValue &ConstantValue) const { 295 assert(Ctx.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 296 297 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 298 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 299 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 300 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 301 switch (Second) { 302 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 303 // 304 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 305 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 306 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 307 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 308 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 309 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 310 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 311 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 312 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue; 313 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 314 if (Initializer && 315 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) { 316 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 317 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 318 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(), 319 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 320 // And back. 321 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue; 322 bool ignored; 323 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 324 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 325 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 326 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 327 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue); 328 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 329 } 330 } else { 331 // Variables are always narrowings. 332 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 333 } 334 } 335 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 336 337 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 338 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 339 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 340 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 341 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 342 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 343 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 344 // FromType is larger than ToType. 345 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 346 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 347 // Constant! 348 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 349 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 350 // Convert the source value into the target type. 351 bool ignored; 352 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 353 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 354 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 355 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 356 // values that can be represented. 357 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) 358 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 359 } else { 360 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 361 } 362 } 363 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 364 365 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 366 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 367 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 368 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 369 // value when converted back to the original type. 370 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too. 371 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 372 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members 373 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions. 374 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 375 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case. 376 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: { 377 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 378 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 379 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 380 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 381 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 382 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 383 384 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 385 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned)) { 386 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 387 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue; 388 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 389 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) { 390 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 391 392 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 393 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 394 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 395 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 396 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 397 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 398 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 399 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 400 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 401 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 402 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 403 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 404 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 405 } else { 406 // Variables are always narrowings. 407 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 408 } 409 } 410 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 411 } 412 413 default: 414 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 415 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 416 } 417} 418 419/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 420/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 421void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 422 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 423 bool PrintedSomething = false; 424 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 425 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 426 PrintedSomething = true; 427 } 428 429 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 430 if (PrintedSomething) { 431 OS << " -> "; 432 } 433 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 434 435 if (CopyConstructor) { 436 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 437 } else if (DirectBinding) { 438 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 439 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 440 OS << " (reference binding)"; 441 } 442 PrintedSomething = true; 443 } 444 445 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 446 if (PrintedSomething) { 447 OS << " -> "; 448 } 449 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 450 PrintedSomething = true; 451 } 452 453 if (!PrintedSomething) { 454 OS << "No conversions required"; 455 } 456} 457 458/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 459/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 460void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 461 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 462 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 463 Before.DebugPrint(); 464 OS << " -> "; 465 } 466 if (ConversionFunction) 467 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 468 else 469 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 470 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 471 OS << " -> "; 472 After.DebugPrint(); 473 } 474} 475 476/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 477/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 478void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 479 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 480 switch (ConversionKind) { 481 case StandardConversion: 482 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 483 Standard.DebugPrint(); 484 break; 485 case UserDefinedConversion: 486 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 487 UserDefined.DebugPrint(); 488 break; 489 case EllipsisConversion: 490 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 491 break; 492 case AmbiguousConversion: 493 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 494 break; 495 case BadConversion: 496 OS << "Bad conversion"; 497 break; 498 } 499 500 OS << "\n"; 501} 502 503void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 504 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 505} 506 507void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 508 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 509} 510 511void 512AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 513 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 514 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 515 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 516} 517 518namespace { 519 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store 520 // template parameter and template argument information. 521 struct DFIParamWithArguments { 522 TemplateParameter Param; 523 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 524 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 525 }; 526} 527 528/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 529/// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 530OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo 531static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 532 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 533 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 534 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result; 535 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 536 Result.Data = 0; 537 switch (TDK) { 538 case Sema::TDK_Success: 539 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 540 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 541 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 542 break; 543 544 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 545 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 546 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 547 break; 548 549 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 550 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 551 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 552 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 553 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 554 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 555 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 556 Result.Data = Saved; 557 break; 558 } 559 560 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 561 Result.Data = Info.take(); 562 break; 563 564 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 565 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 566 break; 567 } 568 569 return Result; 570} 571 572void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 573 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 574 case Sema::TDK_Success: 575 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 576 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 577 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 578 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 579 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 580 break; 581 582 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 583 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 584 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 585 Data = 0; 586 break; 587 588 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 589 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list? 590 Data = 0; 591 break; 592 593 // Unhandled 594 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 595 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 596 break; 597 } 598} 599 600TemplateParameter 601OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 602 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 603 case Sema::TDK_Success: 604 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 605 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 606 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 607 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 608 return TemplateParameter(); 609 610 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 611 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 612 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 613 614 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 615 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 616 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 617 618 // Unhandled 619 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 620 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 621 break; 622 } 623 624 return TemplateParameter(); 625} 626 627TemplateArgumentList * 628OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 629 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 630 case Sema::TDK_Success: 631 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 632 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 633 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 634 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 635 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 636 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 637 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 638 return 0; 639 640 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 641 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 642 643 // Unhandled 644 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 645 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 646 break; 647 } 648 649 return 0; 650} 651 652const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 653 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 654 case Sema::TDK_Success: 655 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 656 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 657 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 658 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 659 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 660 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 661 return 0; 662 663 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 664 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 665 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 666 667 // Unhandled 668 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 669 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 670 break; 671 } 672 673 return 0; 674} 675 676const TemplateArgument * 677OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 678 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 679 case Sema::TDK_Success: 680 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 681 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 682 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 683 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 684 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 685 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 686 return 0; 687 688 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 689 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 690 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 691 692 // Unhandled 693 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 694 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 695 break; 696 } 697 698 return 0; 699} 700 701void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() { 702 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) 703 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii) 704 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 705 NumInlineSequences = 0; 706 Candidates.clear(); 707 Functions.clear(); 708} 709 710namespace { 711 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 712 struct Entry { 713 Expr **Addr; 714 Expr *Saved; 715 }; 716 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 717 718 public: 719 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 720 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 721 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 722 Entries.push_back(entry); 723 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 724 } 725 726 void restore() { 727 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 728 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 729 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 730 } 731 }; 732} 733 734/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 735/// preprocessing on the given expression. 736/// 737/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 738/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 739/// 740/// Return true on unrecoverable error. 741static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 742 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) { 743 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 744 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 745 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 746 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 747 748 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 749 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 750 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 751 unbridgedCasts) { 752 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 753 return false; 754 } 755 756 // Go ahead and check everything else. 757 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 758 if (result.isInvalid()) 759 return true; 760 761 E = result.take(); 762 return false; 763 } 764 765 // Nothing to do. 766 return false; 767} 768 769/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 770/// placeholders. 771static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args, 772 unsigned numArgs, 773 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 774 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i) 775 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged)) 776 return true; 777 778 return false; 779} 780 781// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an 782// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if 783// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same 784// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old 785// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When 786// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New 787// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on 788// top of the underlying declaration. 789// 790// Example: Given the following input: 791// 792// void f(int, float); // #1 793// void f(int, int); // #2 794// int f(int, int); // #3 795// 796// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", 797// so IsOverload will not be used. 798// 799// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By 800// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded 801// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns 802// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged. 803// 804// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We 805// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do 806// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are 807// identical (return types of functions are not part of the 808// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to 809// point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 810// 811// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced 812// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide 813// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure 814// into a function template's signature. 815Sema::OverloadKind 816Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 817 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 818 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 819 I != E; ++I) { 820 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 821 822 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 823 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 824 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 825 826 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 827 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 828 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 829 830 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 831 } 832 833 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 834 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 835 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 836 // function templates hide function templates with different 837 // return types or template parameter lists. 838 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 839 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord(); 840 841 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) { 842 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 843 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 844 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 845 continue; 846 } 847 848 Match = *I; 849 return Ovl_Match; 850 } 851 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) { 852 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 853 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 854 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 855 continue; 856 } 857 858 Match = *I; 859 return Ovl_Match; 860 } 861 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) { 862 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 863 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 864 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 865 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 866 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 867 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 868 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 869 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 870 // template instantiation. 871 } else { 872 // (C++ 13p1): 873 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 874 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 875 Match = *I; 876 return Ovl_NonFunction; 877 } 878 } 879 880 return Ovl_Overload; 881} 882 883bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 884 bool UseUsingDeclRules) { 885 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not 886 // overloads. 887 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC()) 888 return false; 889 890 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 891 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 892 893 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 894 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 895 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 896 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0)) 897 return true; 898 899 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 900 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 901 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 902 903 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 904 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 905 // in the signature, they are overloads. 906 907 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 908 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 909 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 910 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 911 return false; 912 913 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 914 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 915 916 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 917 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 918 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 919 if (OldQType != NewQType && 920 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() || 921 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 922 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 923 return true; 924 925 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 926 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 927 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 928 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 929 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 930 // signature. 931 // 932 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 933 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 934 // 935 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 936 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 937 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 938 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 939 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 940 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 941 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType())) 942 return true; 943 944 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 945 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 946 // 947 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 948 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 949 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 950 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 951 // can be overloaded. 952 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 953 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 954 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 955 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() && 956 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() || 957 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) { 958 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && 959 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() && 960 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 961 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 962 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 963 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 964 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 965 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 966 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 967 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 968 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 969 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 970 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 971 } 972 973 return true; 974 } 975 976 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 977 return false; 978} 979 980/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current 981/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored. 982/// 983/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside 984/// an available function, false otherwise. 985bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) { 986 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable(); 987} 988 989/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 990/// 991/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 992/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 993static ImplicitConversionSequence 994TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 995 bool SuppressUserConversions, 996 bool AllowExplicit, 997 bool InOverloadResolution, 998 bool CStyle, 999 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1000 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1001 1002 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1003 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1004 // we can perform. 1005 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1006 return ICS; 1007 } 1008 1009 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1010 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc()); 1011 OverloadingResult UserDefResult 1012 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions, 1013 AllowExplicit); 1014 1015 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) { 1016 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1017 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1018 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1019 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1020 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1021 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1022 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1023 // called for those cases. 1024 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1025 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1026 QualType FromCanon 1027 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1028 QualType ToCanon 1029 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1030 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1031 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1032 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1033 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1034 ICS.setStandard(); 1035 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1036 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1037 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1038 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1039 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1040 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1041 } 1042 } 1043 1044 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4: 1045 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined 1046 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when 1047 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step 1048 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or 1049 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and 1050 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed. 1051 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) { 1052 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType); 1053 } 1054 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) { 1055 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1056 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1057 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1058 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1059 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1060 if (Cand->Viable) 1061 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 1062 } else { 1063 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1064 } 1065 1066 return ICS; 1067} 1068 1069/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1070/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1071/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1072/// to perform the initialization. Given 1073/// 1074/// void f(float f); 1075/// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1076/// 1077/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1078/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1079/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1080/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1081// 1082/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1083/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1084/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1085/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1086/// "BadConversion". 1087/// 1088/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1089/// not permitted. 1090/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1091/// permitted. 1092/// 1093/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1094/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1095/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1096static ImplicitConversionSequence 1097TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1098 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1099 bool AllowExplicit, 1100 bool InOverloadResolution, 1101 bool CStyle, 1102 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1103 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1104 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1105 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1106 ICS.setStandard(); 1107 return ICS; 1108 } 1109 1110 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) { 1111 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1112 return ICS; 1113 } 1114 1115 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1116 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1117 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1118 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1119 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1120 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1121 // called for those cases. 1122 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1123 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1124 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1125 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) { 1126 ICS.setStandard(); 1127 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1128 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1129 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1130 1131 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1132 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1133 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1134 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1135 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 1136 1137 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1138 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1139 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1140 1141 return ICS; 1142 } 1143 1144 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1145 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1146 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 1147} 1148 1149ImplicitConversionSequence 1150Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1151 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1152 bool AllowExplicit, 1153 bool InOverloadResolution, 1154 bool CStyle, 1155 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1156 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1157 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit, 1158 InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1159 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 1160} 1161 1162/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1163/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1164/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1165/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1166/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1167ExprResult 1168Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1169 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 1170 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1171 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 1172} 1173 1174ExprResult 1175Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1176 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 1177 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 1178 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1179 return ExprError(); 1180 1181 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1182 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1183 = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1184 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1185 1186 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1187 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1188 AllowExplicit, 1189 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1190 /*CStyle=*/false, 1191 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 1192 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1193} 1194 1195/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1196/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type. 1197bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1198 QualType &ResultTy) { 1199 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1200 return false; 1201 1202 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1203 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1204 // - a pointer 1205 // - a member pointer 1206 // - a block pointer 1207 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1208 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1209 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1210 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1211 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1212 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1213 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1214 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1215 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1216 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1217 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1218 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1219 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1220 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1221 } else { 1222 return false; 1223 } 1224 1225 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1226 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1227 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1228 return false; 1229 } 1230 1231 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1232 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1233 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false; 1234 1235 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1236 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1237 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1238 1239 ResultTy = ToType; 1240 return true; 1241} 1242 1243/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1244/// vector conversion. 1245/// 1246/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1247/// conversion. 1248static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType, 1249 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1250 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1251 // conversion. 1252 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1253 return false; 1254 1255 // Identical types require no conversions. 1256 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1257 return false; 1258 1259 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1260 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1261 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1262 // identity conversion. 1263 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1264 return false; 1265 1266 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1267 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1268 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1269 return true; 1270 } 1271 } 1272 1273 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1274 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1275 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1276 // same size 1277 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1278 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1279 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions && 1280 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 1281 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1282 return true; 1283 } 1284 } 1285 1286 return false; 1287} 1288 1289/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1290/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1291/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1292/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1293/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1294/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1295/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1296/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1297static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1298 bool InOverloadResolution, 1299 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1300 bool CStyle, 1301 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1302 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1303 1304 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1305 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1306 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 1307 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1308 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1309 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0; 1310 1311 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1312 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit 1313 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) { 1314 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) 1315 return false; 1316 1317 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions, 1318 } 1319 1320 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1321 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1322 // (C++ 4p1). 1323 1324 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1325 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1326 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1327 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1328 AccessPair)) { 1329 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1330 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1331 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1332 1333 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1334 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1335 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1336 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1337 QualType resultTy; 1338 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1339 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, 1340 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1341 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1342 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1343 return false; 1344 } 1345 1346 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1347 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1348 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1349 // expression. 1350 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1351 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1352 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1353 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1354 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1355 == UO_AddrOf && 1356 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1357 const Type *ClassType 1358 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1359 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1360 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1361 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1362 UO_AddrOf && 1363 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1364 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1365 } 1366 1367 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1368 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1369 FromType, 1370 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1371 } else { 1372 return false; 1373 } 1374 } 1375 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1376 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1377 // be converted to a prvalue. 1378 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1379 if (argIsLValue && 1380 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1381 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1382 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1383 1384 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1385 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1386 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1387 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1388 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1389 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1390 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1391 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1392 1393 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1394 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1395 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1396 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1397 1398 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1399 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4). 1400 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1401 1402 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1403 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1404 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1405 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1406 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1407 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1408 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1409 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1410 return true; 1411 } 1412 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1413 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1414 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1415 1416 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1417 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1418 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1419 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1420 } else { 1421 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1422 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1423 } 1424 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1425 1426 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1427 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1428 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1429 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1430 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1431 // conversion. 1432 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1433 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1434 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1435 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1436 // conversion to do. 1437 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1438 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1439 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1440 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1441 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1442 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1443 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1444 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1445 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1446 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1447 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1448 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1449 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1450 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1451 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1452 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1453 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1454 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 1455 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 1456 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1457 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1458 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1459 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1460 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1461 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1462 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1463 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1464 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) { 1465 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1466 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1467 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1468 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1469 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1470 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1471 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1472 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1473 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1474 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1475 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1476 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1477 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1478 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1479 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1480 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1481 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1482 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1483 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1484 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1485 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1486 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1487 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1488 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1489 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1490 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1491 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1492 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1493 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1494 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1495 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1496 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1497 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1498 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1499 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1500 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1501 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1502 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1503 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1504 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1505 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1506 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1507 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1508 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion. 1509 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment; 1510 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1511 InOverloadResolution, 1512 SCS, CStyle)) { 1513 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1514 FromType = ToType; 1515 } else { 1516 // No second conversion required. 1517 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1518 } 1519 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1520 1521 QualType CanonFrom; 1522 QualType CanonTo; 1523 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1). 1524 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1525 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1526 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1527 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1528 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1529 FromType = ToType; 1530 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1531 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1532 } else { 1533 // No conversion required 1534 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1535 1536 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1537 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1538 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1539 // a conversion. [...] 1540 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1541 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1542 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1543 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1544 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers() 1545 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr() 1546 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) { 1547 FromType = ToType; 1548 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1549 } 1550 } 1551 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1552 1553 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1554 // this is a bad conversion sequence. 1555 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo) 1556 return false; 1557 1558 return true; 1559} 1560 1561static bool 1562IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 1563 QualType &ToType, 1564 bool InOverloadResolution, 1565 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1566 bool CStyle) { 1567 1568 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 1569 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 1570 return false; 1571 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 1572 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 1573 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 1574 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(), 1575 itend = UD->field_end(); 1576 it != itend; ++it) { 1577 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1578 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 1579 ToType = it->getType(); 1580 return true; 1581 } 1582 } 1583 return false; 1584} 1585 1586/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 1587/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 1588/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 1589/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1590bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1591 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1592 // All integers are built-in. 1593 if (!To) { 1594 return false; 1595 } 1596 1597 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 1598 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 1599 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 1600 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 1601 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 1602 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 1603 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 1604 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 1605 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 1606 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 1607 // less than int to an int. 1608 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && 1609 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 1610 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1611 } 1612 1613 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1614 } 1615 1616 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3: 1617 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 1618 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 1619 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 1620 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 1621 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 1622 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 1623 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 1624 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 1625 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 1626 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 1627 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 1628 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 1629 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 1630 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 1631 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 1632 return false; 1633 1634 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 1635 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 1636 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag())) 1637 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, 1638 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 1639 } 1640 1641 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 1642 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 1643 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 1644 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 1645 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 1646 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 1647 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 1648 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 1649 // type. 1650 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 1651 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 1652 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 1653 // unsigned. 1654 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 1655 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 1656 1657 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 1658 // order. Try each of these types. 1659 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 1660 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 1661 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 1662 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 1663 }; 1664 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 1665 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 1666 if (FromSize < ToSize || 1667 (FromSize == ToSize && 1668 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 1669 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 1670 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 1671 // promotion. 1672 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 1673 } 1674 } 1675 } 1676 1677 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 1678 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 1679 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 1680 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 1681 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 1682 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 1683 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 1684 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 1685 // conversion. 1686 using llvm::APSInt; 1687 if (From) 1688 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) { 1689 APSInt BitWidth; 1690 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 1691 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 1692 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 1693 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 1694 1695 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 1696 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 1697 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 1698 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1699 } 1700 1701 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 1702 // that fits into an unsigned int? 1703 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 1704 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1705 } 1706 1707 return false; 1708 } 1709 } 1710 1711 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 1712 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 1713 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 1714 return true; 1715 } 1716 1717 return false; 1718} 1719 1720/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 1721/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 1722/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1723bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1724 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 1725 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 1726 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 1727 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 1728 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 1729 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 1730 return true; 1731 1732 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 1733 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 1734 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 1735 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1736 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 1737 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 1738 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble)) 1739 return true; 1740 1741 // Half can be promoted to float. 1742 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 1743 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 1744 return true; 1745 } 1746 1747 return false; 1748} 1749 1750/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 1751/// 1752/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 1753/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 1754/// floating-point or integral promotion. 1755bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1756 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1757 if (!FromComplex) 1758 return false; 1759 1760 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1761 if (!ToComplex) 1762 return false; 1763 1764 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 1765 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 1766 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(), 1767 ToComplex->getElementType()); 1768} 1769 1770/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 1771/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 1772/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 1773/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 1774/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 1775/// 1776static QualType 1777BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 1778 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 1779 ASTContext &Context, 1780 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 1781 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 1782 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 1783 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 1784 1785 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 1786 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 1787 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1788 1789 QualType CanonFromPointee 1790 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 1791 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 1792 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 1793 1794 if (StripObjCLifetime) 1795 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 1796 1797 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 1798 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 1799 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 1800 if (!ToType.isNull()) 1801 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1802 1803 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 1804 // already. 1805 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 1806 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 1807 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 1808 } 1809 1810 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 1811 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 1812 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 1813 1814 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 1815 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 1816 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 1817} 1818 1819static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 1820 bool InOverloadResolution, 1821 ASTContext &Context) { 1822 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 1823 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 1824 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 1825 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 1826 return !InOverloadResolution; 1827 1828 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 1829 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 1830 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 1831} 1832 1833/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 1834/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 1835/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 1836/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 1837/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 1838/// ConvertedType. 1839/// 1840/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 1841/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 1842/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 1843/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 1844/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 1845/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 1846/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 1847/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 1848/// should result in a warning. 1849bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1850 bool InOverloadResolution, 1851 QualType& ConvertedType, 1852 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 1853 IncompatibleObjC = false; 1854 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 1855 IncompatibleObjC)) 1856 return true; 1857 1858 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 1859 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 1860 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1861 ConvertedType = ToType; 1862 return true; 1863 } 1864 1865 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 1866 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 1867 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 1868 ConvertedType = ToType; 1869 return true; 1870 } 1871 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 1872 // pointer type. 1873 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 1874 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1875 ConvertedType = ToType; 1876 return true; 1877 } 1878 1879 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 1880 // pointer constant. 1881 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 1882 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1883 ConvertedType = ToType; 1884 return true; 1885 } 1886 1887 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 1888 if (!ToTypePtr) 1889 return false; 1890 1891 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 1892 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 1893 ConvertedType = ToType; 1894 return true; 1895 } 1896 1897 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 1898 // , including objective-c pointers. 1899 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 1900 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 1901 !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 1902 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 1903 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 1904 ToPointeeType, 1905 ToType, Context); 1906 return true; 1907 } 1908 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 1909 if (!FromTypePtr) 1910 return false; 1911 1912 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 1913 1914 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 1915 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 1916 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 1917 return false; 1918 1919 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 1920 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 1921 // 4.10p2). 1922 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 1923 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 1924 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1925 ToPointeeType, 1926 ToType, Context, 1927 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 1928 return true; 1929 } 1930 1931 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 1932 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 1933 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 1934 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1935 ToPointeeType, 1936 ToType, Context); 1937 return true; 1938 } 1939 1940 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 1941 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 1942 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1943 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 1944 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1945 ToPointeeType, 1946 ToType, Context); 1947 return true; 1948 } 1949 1950 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 1951 // 1952 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 1953 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 1954 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 1955 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 1956 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 1957 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 1958 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 1959 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 1960 // 1961 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 1962 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 1963 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && 1964 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 1965 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 1966 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) && 1967 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 1968 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1969 ToPointeeType, 1970 ToType, Context); 1971 return true; 1972 } 1973 1974 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 1975 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 1976 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 1977 ToPointeeType, 1978 ToType, Context); 1979 return true; 1980 } 1981 1982 return false; 1983} 1984 1985/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 1986static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 1987 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 1988 1989 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 1990 if (TQs == Qs) 1991 return T; 1992 1993 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 1994 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 1995 1996 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 1997} 1998 1999/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2000/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2001/// with the same arguments and return values. 2002bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2003 QualType& ConvertedType, 2004 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2005 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) 2006 return false; 2007 2008 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2009 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2010 2011 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2012 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2013 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2014 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2015 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2016 2017 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2018 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2019 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2020 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2021 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2022 return false; 2023 2024 // Check for compatible 2025 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a 2026 // pointer to any interface (in both directions). 2027 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2028 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2029 return true; 2030 } 2031 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>. 2032 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 2033 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 2034 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType, 2035 /*compare=*/false)) { 2036 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2037 return true; 2038 } 2039 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an 2040 // interface to a pointer to a different interface. 2041 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2042 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2043 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2044 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2045 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2046 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2047 return false; 2048 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2049 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2050 ToType, Context); 2051 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2052 return true; 2053 } 2054 2055 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2056 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2057 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2058 // complain about it. 2059 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2060 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2061 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2062 ToType, Context); 2063 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2064 return true; 2065 } 2066 } 2067 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2068 QualType ToPointeeType; 2069 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2070 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2071 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2072 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2073 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2074 // to a block pointer type. 2075 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2076 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2077 return true; 2078 } 2079 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2080 } 2081 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2082 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2083 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2084 // pointer to any object. 2085 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2086 return true; 2087 } 2088 else 2089 return false; 2090 2091 QualType FromPointeeType; 2092 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2093 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2094 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2095 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2096 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2097 else 2098 return false; 2099 2100 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2101 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2102 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2103 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2104 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2105 // We always complain about this conversion. 2106 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2107 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2108 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2109 return true; 2110 } 2111 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2112 // as in I* to id. 2113 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2114 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2115 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2116 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2117 2118 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2119 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2120 return true; 2121 } 2122 2123 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2124 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2125 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2126 // complain about it). 2127 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2128 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2129 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2130 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2131 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2132 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2133 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2134 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2135 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2136 return false; 2137 2138 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2139 // function types are obviously different. 2140 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() || 2141 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2142 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals()) 2143 return false; 2144 2145 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2146 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType()) 2147 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) { 2148 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2149 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(), 2150 ToFunctionType->getResultType(), 2151 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2152 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2153 HasObjCConversion = true; 2154 } else { 2155 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2156 return false; 2157 } 2158 2159 // Check argument types. 2160 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs(); 2161 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2162 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 2163 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 2164 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2165 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2166 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2167 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2168 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2169 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2170 HasObjCConversion = true; 2171 } else { 2172 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2173 return false; 2174 } 2175 } 2176 2177 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2178 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2179 // conversion, but complain about it. 2180 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2181 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2182 return true; 2183 } 2184 } 2185 2186 return false; 2187} 2188 2189/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2190/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2191/// 2192/// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2193/// 2194/// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2195/// 2196/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2197/// this conversion. 2198bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2199 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2200 if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2201 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2202 return false; 2203 2204 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2205 QualType ToPointee; 2206 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2207 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2208 else 2209 return false; 2210 2211 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2212 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2213 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2214 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2215 return false; 2216 2217 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2218 QualType FromPointee; 2219 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2220 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2221 else 2222 return false; 2223 2224 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2225 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2226 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2227 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2228 return false; 2229 2230 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2231 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2232 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2233 return false; 2234 2235 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2236 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2237 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2238 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2239 2240 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2241 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2242 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2243 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2244 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2245 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2246 IncompatibleObjC)) 2247 return false; 2248 2249 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2250 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2251 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2252 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2253 return true; 2254} 2255 2256bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2257 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2258 QualType ToPointeeType; 2259 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2260 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2261 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2262 else 2263 return false; 2264 2265 QualType FromPointeeType; 2266 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2267 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2268 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2269 else 2270 return false; 2271 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2272 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2273 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2274 2275 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2276 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2277 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2278 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2279 2280 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2281 return false; 2282 2283 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2284 return true; 2285 2286 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2287 // function types are obviously different. 2288 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() || 2289 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2290 return false; 2291 2292 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2293 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2294 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2295 return false; 2296 2297 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2298 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(), 2299 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) { 2300 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2301 } else { 2302 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType(); 2303 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType(); 2304 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2305 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2306 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2307 2308 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2309 // OK exact match. 2310 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2311 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2312 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2313 return false; 2314 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2315 } 2316 else 2317 return false; 2318 } 2319 2320 // Check argument types. 2321 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs(); 2322 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2323 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2324 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 2325 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 2326 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2327 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2328 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2329 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2330 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2331 return false; 2332 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2333 } else 2334 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2335 return false; 2336 } 2337 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount && 2338 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType, 2339 ToFunctionType)) 2340 return false; 2341 2342 ConvertedType = ToType; 2343 return true; 2344} 2345 2346enum { 2347 ft_default, 2348 ft_different_class, 2349 ft_parameter_arity, 2350 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2351 ft_return_type, 2352 ft_qualifer_mismatch 2353}; 2354 2355/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2356/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2357/// parameter types, and different return types. 2358void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2359 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2360 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2361 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2362 PDiag << ft_default; 2363 return; 2364 } 2365 2366 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2367 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2368 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2369 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2370 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) { 2371 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2372 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2373 return; 2374 } 2375 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2376 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2377 } 2378 2379 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2380 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2381 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2382 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2383 2384 // Remove references. 2385 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2386 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2387 2388 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2389 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2390 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2391 PDiag << ft_default; 2392 return; 2393 } 2394 2395 // No extra info for same types. 2396 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2397 PDiag << ft_default; 2398 return; 2399 } 2400 2401 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), 2402 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2403 2404 // Both types need to be function types. 2405 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2406 PDiag << ft_default; 2407 return; 2408 } 2409 2410 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) { 2411 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs() 2412 << FromFunction->getNumArgs(); 2413 return; 2414 } 2415 2416 // Handle different parameter types. 2417 unsigned ArgPos; 2418 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2419 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2420 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos) 2421 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos); 2422 return; 2423 } 2424 2425 // Handle different return type. 2426 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(), 2427 ToFunction->getResultType())) { 2428 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType() 2429 << FromFunction->getResultType(); 2430 return; 2431 } 2432 2433 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(), 2434 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals(); 2435 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) { 2436 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals; 2437 return; 2438 } 2439 2440 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2441 PDiag << ft_default; 2442} 2443 2444/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2445/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2446/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C 2447/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal. 2448/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the the parameter index 2449/// of the first different parameter. 2450bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2451 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2452 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2453 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) { 2454 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(), 2455 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(), 2456 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2457 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) { 2458 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin(); 2459 return false; 2460 } 2461 } 2462 return true; 2463 } 2464 2465 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(), 2466 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(), 2467 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2468 QualType ToType = (*O); 2469 QualType FromType = (*N); 2470 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) { 2471 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2472 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2473 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && 2474 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) || 2475 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && 2476 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType())) 2477 continue; 2478 } 2479 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo = 2480 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2481 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr = 2482 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 2483 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2484 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(), 2485 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType())) 2486 continue; 2487 } 2488 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin(); 2489 return false; 2490 } 2491 } 2492 return true; 2493} 2494 2495/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2496/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2497/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2498/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2499/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2500/// error, or returns false otherwise. 2501bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2502 CastKind &Kind, 2503 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2504 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 2505 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2506 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2507 2508 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2509 2510 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 2511 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) && 2512 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 2513 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 2514 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 2515 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 2516 2517 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2518 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2519 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 2520 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2521 2522 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2523 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2524 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 2525 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 2526 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, 2527 From->getExprLoc(), 2528 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath, 2529 IgnoreBaseAccess)) 2530 return true; 2531 2532 // The conversion was successful. 2533 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 2534 } 2535 } 2536 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 2537 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2538 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 2539 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2540 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 2541 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 2542 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 2543 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 2544 return false; 2545 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2546 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2547 } else { 2548 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2549 } 2550 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2551 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 2552 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 2553 } 2554 2555 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 2556 // reasons. 2557 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 2558 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 2559 2560 return false; 2561} 2562 2563/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2564/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 2565/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 2566/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 2567/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 2568bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 2569 QualType ToType, 2570 bool InOverloadResolution, 2571 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2572 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2573 if (!ToTypePtr) 2574 return false; 2575 2576 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 2577 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2578 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2579 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 2580 ConvertedType = ToType; 2581 return true; 2582 } 2583 2584 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 2585 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2586 if (!FromTypePtr) 2587 return false; 2588 2589 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 2590 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 2591 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2592 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2593 2594 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 2595 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) && 2596 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) { 2597 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 2598 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 2599 return true; 2600 } 2601 2602 return false; 2603} 2604 2605/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 2606/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 2607/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 2608/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 2609/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 2610/// otherwise. 2611bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2612 CastKind &Kind, 2613 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 2614 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 2615 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2616 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2617 if (!FromPtrType) { 2618 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 2619 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2620 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 2621 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 2622 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 2623 return false; 2624 } 2625 2626 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2627 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 2628 "that is not a member pointer."); 2629 2630 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 2631 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 2632 2633 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 2634 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 2635 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 2636 2637 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 2638 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 2639 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 2640 assert(DerivationOkay && 2641 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 2642 (void)DerivationOkay; 2643 2644 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 2645 getUnqualifiedType())) { 2646 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 2647 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 2648 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 2649 return true; 2650 } 2651 2652 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 2653 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 2654 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 2655 << From->getSourceRange(); 2656 return true; 2657 } 2658 2659 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 2660 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 2661 Paths.front(), 2662 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 2663 2664 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 2665 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 2666 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 2667 return false; 2668} 2669 2670/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 2671/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 2672/// (C++ 4.4). 2673/// 2674/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 2675/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 2676/// object lifetime. 2677bool 2678Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2679 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 2680 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 2681 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 2682 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 2683 2684 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 2685 // qualification conversion. 2686 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 2687 return false; 2688 2689 // (C++ 4.4p4): 2690 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 2691 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 2692 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 2693 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 2694 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 2695 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 2696 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 2697 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 2698 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 2699 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to 2700 // unwrap. 2701 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 2702 2703 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2704 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 2705 2706 // Objective-C ARC: 2707 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 2708 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() && 2709 UnwrappedAnyPointer) { 2710 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 2711 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 2712 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2713 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2714 } else { 2715 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 2716 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 2717 return false; 2718 } 2719 } 2720 2721 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 2722 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 2723 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 2724 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 2725 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 2726 } 2727 2728 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 2729 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 2730 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2731 return false; 2732 2733 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 2734 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 2735 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() 2736 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 2737 return false; 2738 2739 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 2740 // include const. 2741 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst 2742 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 2743 } 2744 2745 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 2746 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 2747 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 2748 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 2749 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 2750 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 2751} 2752 2753static OverloadingResult 2754IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2755 CXXRecordDecl *To, 2756 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 2757 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 2758 bool AllowExplicit) { 2759 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd; 2760 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(To); 2761 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 2762 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 2763 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 2764 2765 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 2766 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0; 2767 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 2768 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 2769 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2770 Constructor 2771 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 2772 else 2773 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 2774 2775 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 2776 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) && 2777 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit()); 2778 if (Usable) { 2779 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2780 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 2781 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 2782 From, CandidateSet, 2783 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true); 2784 else 2785 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 2786 From, CandidateSet, 2787 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true); 2788 } 2789 } 2790 2791 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 2792 2793 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2794 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) { 2795 case OR_Success: { 2796 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 2797 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 2798 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor); 2799 2800 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 2801 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 2802 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 2803 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 2804 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 2805 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 2806 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 2807 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 2808 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 2809 return OR_Success; 2810 } 2811 2812 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 2813 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 2814 case OR_Deleted: 2815 return OR_Deleted; 2816 case OR_Ambiguous: 2817 return OR_Ambiguous; 2818 } 2819 2820 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 2821} 2822 2823/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 2824/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 2825/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 2826/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 2827/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 2828/// false and User is unspecified. 2829/// 2830/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 2831/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 2832/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 2833static OverloadingResult 2834IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2835 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 2836 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 2837 bool AllowExplicit) { 2838 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 2839 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 2840 2841 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 2842 // constructors. 2843 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2844 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 2845 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 2846 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 2847 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 2848 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 2849 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 2850 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 2851 // the parentheses of the initializer. 2852 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 2853 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 2854 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType))) 2855 ConstructorsOnly = true; 2856 2857 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag()); 2858 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl 2859 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now 2860 // to try to recover. 2861 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) { 2862 // We're not going to find any constructors. 2863 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 2864 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 2865 2866 Expr **Args = &From; 2867 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 2868 bool ListInitializing = false; 2869 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 2870 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work. 2871 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 2872 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit); 2873 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 2874 return Result; 2875 // Never mind. 2876 CandidateSet.clear(); 2877 2878 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 2879 // arguments, not the entire list. 2880 Args = InitList->getInits(); 2881 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 2882 ListInitializing = true; 2883 } 2884 2885 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd; 2886 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl); 2887 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 2888 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 2889 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 2890 2891 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 2892 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0; 2893 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 2894 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 2895 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2896 Constructor 2897 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 2898 else 2899 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 2900 2901 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 2902 if (ListInitializing) 2903 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit()); 2904 else 2905 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit); 2906 if (Usable) { 2907 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2908 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 2909 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 2910 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 2911 CandidateSet, 2912 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ 2913 !ConstructorsOnly && 2914 !ListInitializing); 2915 else 2916 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 2917 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 2918 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 2919 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 2920 CandidateSet, 2921 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ 2922 !ConstructorsOnly && !ListInitializing); 2923 } 2924 } 2925 } 2926 } 2927 2928 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 2929 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 2930 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 2931 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) { 2932 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 2933 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType 2934 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2935 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 2936 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 2937 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 2938 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 2939 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 2940 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 2941 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 2942 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 2943 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 2944 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 2945 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2946 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2947 2948 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 2949 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 2950 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 2951 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 2952 else 2953 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 2954 2955 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 2956 if (ConvTemplate) 2957 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, 2958 ActingContext, From, ToType, 2959 CandidateSet); 2960 else 2961 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 2962 From, ToType, CandidateSet); 2963 } 2964 } 2965 } 2966 } 2967 2968 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 2969 2970 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2971 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) { 2972 case OR_Success: 2973 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 2974 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 2975 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 2976 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor); 2977 2978 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 2979 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 2980 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 2981 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 2982 // the argument of the constructor. 2983 // 2984 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 2985 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 2986 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 2987 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 2988 } else { 2989 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 2990 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 2991 else { 2992 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 2993 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 2994 } 2995 } 2996 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 2997 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 2998 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 2999 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3000 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3001 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3002 return OR_Success; 3003 } 3004 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3005 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3006 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion); 3007 3008 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3009 // 3010 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3011 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3012 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3013 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3014 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3015 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3016 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3017 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3018 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3019 3020 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3021 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3022 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3023 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3024 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3025 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3026 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3027 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3028 // 13.3.3.1). 3029 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3030 return OR_Success; 3031 } 3032 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3033 3034 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3035 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3036 case OR_Deleted: 3037 // No conversion here! We're done. 3038 return OR_Deleted; 3039 3040 case OR_Ambiguous: 3041 return OR_Ambiguous; 3042 } 3043 3044 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3045} 3046 3047bool 3048Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3049 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3050 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc()); 3051 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3052 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3053 CandidateSet, false); 3054 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3055 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 3056 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3057 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3058 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) 3059 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 3060 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3061 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3062 else 3063 return false; 3064 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From); 3065 return true; 3066} 3067 3068/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3069/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3070/// is possible. 3071static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3072compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, 3073 FunctionDecl *Function1, 3074 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3075 if (!S.getLangOptions().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) 3076 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3077 3078 // Objective-C++: 3079 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3080 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3081 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3082 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3083 // to keep code working. 3084 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3085 if (!Conv1) 3086 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3087 3088 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3089 if (!Conv2) 3090 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3091 3092 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 3093 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3094 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3095 if (Block1 != Block2) 3096 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3097 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3098 } 3099 3100 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3101} 3102 3103/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3104/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3105/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3106static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3107CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, 3108 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3109 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3110{ 3111 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3112 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3113 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3114 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3115 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3116 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3117 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3118 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3119 // 3120 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3121 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3122 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3123 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3124 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3125 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3126 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3127 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3128 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3129 3130 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3131 // the same kind. 3132 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3133 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3134 3135 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3136 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3137 3138 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3139 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3140 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3141 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3142 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 3143 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3144 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3145 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3146 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3147 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3148 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3149 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3150 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3151 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3152 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3153 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 3154 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3155 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3156 else 3157 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3158 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3159 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3160 } 3161 3162 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3163 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> 3164 // for some X and L2 does not. 3165 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable && 3166 !ICS1.isBad() && 3167 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() && 3168 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) { 3169 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3170 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3171 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3172 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3173 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3174 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3175 } 3176 3177 return Result; 3178} 3179 3180static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) { 3181 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3182 Qualifiers Quals; 3183 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 3184 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 3185 } 3186 3187 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2); 3188} 3189 3190// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3191// determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3192static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3193compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3194 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3195 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3196 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3197 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3198 3199 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3200 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3201 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3202 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3203 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3204 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3205 3206 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3207 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3208 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3209 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3210 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3211 else 3212 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3213 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3214 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3215 3216 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3217 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3218 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3219 } 3220 3221 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3222 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3223 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3224 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3225 3226 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3227 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3228 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3229 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3230 3231 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3232} 3233 3234/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3235/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3236static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3237 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3238 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3239 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3240 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3241 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3242 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3243 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3244 // reference*. 3245 // 3246 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3247 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3248 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3249 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3250 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3251 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3252 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3253 return false; 3254 3255 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3256 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3257 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3258 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference); 3259} 3260 3261/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3262/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3263/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3264static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3265CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 3266 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3267 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3268{ 3269 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3270 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3271 3272 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3273 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3274 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3275 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3276 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3277 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3278 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3279 return CK; 3280 3281 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3282 // defined below), or, if not that, 3283 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3284 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3285 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3286 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3287 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3288 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3289 3290 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3291 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3292 // applies: 3293 3294 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3295 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3296 // that is such a conversion. 3297 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3298 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3299 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3300 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3301 3302 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3303 // 3304 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3305 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3306 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 3307 // of B* to void*. 3308 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 3309 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3310 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 3311 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3312 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3313 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 3314 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 3315 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3316 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3317 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3318 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 3319 // their derived-to-base conversions. 3320 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 3321 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 3322 return DerivedCK; 3323 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 3324 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 3325 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 3326 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 3327 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 3328 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3329 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3330 3331 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3332 // conversion, if we need to. 3333 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3334 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3335 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3336 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3337 3338 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3339 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3340 3341 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3342 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3343 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3344 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3345 3346 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 3347 // other, it is the better one. 3348 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 3349 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3350 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 3351 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3352 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 3353 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 3354 FromObjCPtr2); 3355 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 3356 FromObjCPtr1); 3357 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 3358 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3359 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3360 } 3361 } 3362 } 3363 3364 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 3365 // bullet 3). 3366 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 3367 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 3368 return QualCK; 3369 3370 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 3371 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 3372 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 3373 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3374 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 3375 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3376 3377 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3378 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 3379 // which the references refer are the same type except for 3380 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 3381 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 3382 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 3383 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3384 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3385 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3386 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3387 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3388 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3389 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3390 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 3391 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 3392 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 3393 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 3394 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 3395 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 3396 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3397 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3398 } 3399 3400 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 3401 // type for comparison. 3402 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3403 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3404 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3405 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3406 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 3407 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3408 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 3409 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3410 } 3411 } 3412 3413 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 3414 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 3415 // is between types of the same size. 3416 // For example: 3417 // void f(float); 3418 // void f(int); 3419 // int main { 3420 // long a; 3421 // f(a); 3422 // } 3423 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 3424 // as clang will do in standard mode. 3425 if (S.getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode && 3426 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 3427 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 3428 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 3429 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 3430 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3431 3432 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3433} 3434 3435/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3436/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3437/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 3438ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3439CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 3440 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3441 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3442 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 3443 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 3444 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 3445 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 3446 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 3447 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 3448 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 3449 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 3450 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3451 3452 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 3453 // conversion (!) 3454 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3455 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3456 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3457 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3458 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3459 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3460 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3461 3462 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped 3463 // them. 3464 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 3465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3466 3467 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 3468 // for comparison. 3469 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3470 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3471 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3472 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3473 3474 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3475 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3476 3477 // Objective-C++ ARC: 3478 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 3479 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 3480 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 3481 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 3482 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3483 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3484 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3485 } 3486 3487 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3488 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 3489 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 3490 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 3491 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 3492 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 3493 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 3494 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 3495 // strict subset of qualifiers. 3496 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers()) 3497 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 3498 // about how the sequences rank. 3499 ; 3500 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 3501 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3502 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 3503 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3504 // qualifiers. 3505 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3506 3507 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3508 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 3509 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3510 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 3511 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3512 // qualifiers. 3513 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3514 3515 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3516 } else { 3517 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 3518 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3519 } 3520 3521 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 3522 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 3523 break; 3524 } 3525 3526 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 3527 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 3528 switch (Result) { 3529 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 3530 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3531 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3532 break; 3533 3534 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 3535 break; 3536 3537 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 3538 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3539 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3540 break; 3541 } 3542 3543 return Result; 3544} 3545 3546/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3547/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3548/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 3549/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 3550/// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 3551ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3552CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 3553 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3554 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3555 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3556 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 3557 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3558 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 3559 3560 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3561 // conversion, if we need to. 3562 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3563 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3564 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3565 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3566 3567 // Canonicalize all of the types. 3568 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 3569 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 3570 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 3571 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 3572 3573 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 3574 // 3575 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 3576 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 3577 // 3578 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 3579 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3580 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3581 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 3582 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 3583 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 3584 QualType FromPointee1 3585 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3586 QualType ToPointee1 3587 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3588 QualType FromPointee2 3589 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3590 QualType ToPointee2 3591 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3592 3593 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 3594 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 3595 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 3596 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3597 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 3598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3599 } 3600 3601 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 3602 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 3603 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3604 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3605 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3606 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3607 } 3608 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3609 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 3610 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 3611 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3612 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 3613 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3614 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 3615 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3616 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 3617 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3618 3619 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 3620 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 3621 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 3622 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 3623 // Objective-C pointer types. 3624 bool FromAssignLeft 3625 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 3626 bool FromAssignRight 3627 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 3628 bool ToAssignLeft 3629 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 3630 bool ToAssignRight 3631 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 3632 3633 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 3634 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 3635 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 3636 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 3637 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3638 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 3639 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 3640 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3641 3642 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 3643 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 3644 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 3645 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3646 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 3647 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3648 3649 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 3650 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 3651 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 3652 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 3653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3654 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 3655 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 3656 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3657 3658 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 3659 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 3660 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 3661 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3662 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 3663 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3664 3665 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 3666 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 3667 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 3668 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) 3669 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3670 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3671 3672 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 3673 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 3674 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 3675 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3676 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3677 } 3678 } 3679 3680 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 3681 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 3682 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 3683 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 3684 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 = 3685 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3686 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 = 3687 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3688 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 = 3689 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3690 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 = 3691 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3692 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 3693 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 3694 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 3695 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 3696 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3697 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3698 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3699 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3700 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 3701 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 3702 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 3703 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3704 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 3705 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3706 } 3707 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 3708 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 3709 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3710 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3711 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3712 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3713 } 3714 } 3715 3716 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 3717 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 3718 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 3719 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 3720 // reference of type A&, 3721 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 3722 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 3723 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2)) 3724 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3725 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1)) 3726 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3727 } 3728 3729 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 3730 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 3731 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 3732 // reference of type A&, 3733 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 3734 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 3735 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1)) 3736 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3737 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2)) 3738 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3739 } 3740 } 3741 3742 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3743} 3744 3745/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 3746/// determine whether they are reference-related, 3747/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added 3748/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 3749/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 3750/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 3751/// type being initialized. 3752Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 3753Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 3754 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 3755 bool &DerivedToBase, 3756 bool &ObjCConversion, 3757 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3758 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 3759 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 3760 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 3761 3762 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 3763 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 3764 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3765 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3766 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3767 3768 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 3769 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 3770 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or 3771 // T1 is a base class of T2. 3772 DerivedToBase = false; 3773 ObjCConversion = false; 3774 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3775 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 3776 // Nothing to do. 3777 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) && 3778 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 3779 DerivedToBase = true; 3780 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 3781 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 3782 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 3783 ObjCConversion = true; 3784 else 3785 return Ref_Incompatible; 3786 3787 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at 3788 // least). 3789 3790 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 3791 // for comparison. 3792 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3793 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3794 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3795 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3796 3797 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 3798 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is 3799 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification 3800 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of 3801 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater 3802 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as 3803 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2). 3804 // 3805 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space 3806 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in 3807 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address 3808 // space 2. 3809 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() && 3810 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) { 3811 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3812 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3813 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3814 } 3815 3816 if (T1Quals == T2Quals) 3817 return Ref_Compatible; 3818 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 3819 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification; 3820 else 3821 return Ref_Related; 3822} 3823 3824/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible 3825/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 3826static bool 3827FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 3828 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 3829 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 3830 bool AllowExplicit) { 3831 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 3832 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl 3833 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 3834 3835 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc); 3836 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 3837 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3838 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 3839 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 3840 NamedDecl *D = *I; 3841 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3842 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3843 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3844 3845 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 3846 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 3847 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3848 if (ConvTemplate) 3849 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3850 else 3851 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3852 3853 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider 3854 // explicit conversions, skip it. 3855 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit()) 3856 continue; 3857 3858 if (AllowRvalues) { 3859 bool DerivedToBase = false; 3860 bool ObjCConversion = false; 3861 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3862 3863 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 3864 // functions that return lvalues. 3865 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 3866 const ReferenceType *RefType 3867 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 3868 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 3869 continue; 3870 } 3871 3872 if (!ConvTemplate && 3873 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 3874 DeclLoc, 3875 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType() 3876 .getUnqualifiedType(), 3877 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 3878 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) == 3879 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 3880 continue; 3881 } else { 3882 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 3883 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 3884 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 3885 3886 const ReferenceType *RefType = 3887 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 3888 if (!RefType || 3889 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 3890 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 3891 continue; 3892 } 3893 3894 if (ConvTemplate) 3895 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, 3896 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet); 3897 else 3898 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, 3899 DeclType, CandidateSet); 3900 } 3901 3902 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3903 3904 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3905 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) { 3906 case OR_Success: 3907 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 3908 // 3909 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 3910 // applying a conversion function to the argument 3911 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 3912 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 3913 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 3914 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 3915 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 3916 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 3917 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 3918 return false; 3919 3920 if (Best->Function) 3921 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function); 3922 ICS.setUserDefined(); 3923 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3924 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3925 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3926 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 3927 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3928 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 3929 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 3930 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 3931 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 3932 return true; 3933 3934 case OR_Ambiguous: 3935 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 3936 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 3937 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 3938 if (Cand->Viable) 3939 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 3940 return true; 3941 3942 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3943 case OR_Deleted: 3944 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 3945 // conversion; continue with other checks. 3946 return false; 3947 } 3948 3949 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3950} 3951 3952/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 3953/// initialization. 3954static ImplicitConversionSequence 3955TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 3956 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 3957 bool SuppressUserConversions, 3958 bool AllowExplicit) { 3959 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 3960 3961 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 3962 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3963 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 3964 3965 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 3966 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 3967 3968 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 3969 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 3970 // type of the resulting function. 3971 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 3972 DeclAccessPair Found; 3973 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 3974 false, Found)) 3975 T2 = Fn->getType(); 3976 } 3977 3978 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 3979 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 3980 bool DerivedToBase = false; 3981 bool ObjCConversion = false; 3982 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3983 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 3984 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 3985 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase, 3986 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion); 3987 3988 3989 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 3990 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 3991 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 3992 3993 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 3994 if (!isRValRef) { 3995 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 3996 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 3997 // 3998 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 3999 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && 4000 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) { 4001 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4002 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4003 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4004 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4005 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4006 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4007 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4008 ICS.setStandard(); 4009 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4010 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4011 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4012 : ICK_Identity; 4013 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4014 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4015 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4016 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4017 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4018 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4019 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 4020 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4021 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4022 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false; 4023 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4024 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4025 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 4026 4027 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4028 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4029 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4030 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4031 return ICS; 4032 } 4033 4034 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4035 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4036 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4037 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4038 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4039 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4040 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4041 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4042 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 4043 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4044 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4045 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4046 AllowExplicit)) 4047 return ICS; 4048 } 4049 } 4050 4051 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4052 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4053 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4054 // 4055 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this 4056 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference 4057 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct 4058 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile 4059 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence 4060 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only 4061 // qualifier. 4062 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer 4063 // go together. 4064 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified()) 4065 return ICS; 4066 4067 // -- If the initializer expression 4068 // 4069 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4070 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4071 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification && 4072 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4073 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4074 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4075 ICS.setStandard(); 4076 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4077 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4078 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4079 : ICK_Identity; 4080 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4081 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4082 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4083 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4084 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4085 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4086 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4087 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4088 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4089 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4090 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4091 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = 4092 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x || 4093 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType()); 4094 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4095 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4096 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4097 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4098 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4099 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 4100 return ICS; 4101 } 4102 4103 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4104 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4105 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4106 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4107 // "cv3 T3", 4108 // 4109 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4110 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4111 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4112 // class subobject). 4113 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4114 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 4115 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4116 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4117 AllowExplicit)) { 4118 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4119 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4120 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4121 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4122 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4123 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4124 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4125 4126 return ICS; 4127 } 4128 4129 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4130 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4131 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4132 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4133 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4134 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4135 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4136 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4137 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4138 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4139 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4140 // initialization fails. 4141 // 4142 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4143 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important. 4144 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4145 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4146 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4147 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4148 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4149 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4150 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4151 return ICS; 4152 } 4153 4154 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4155 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4156 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4157 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4158 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4159 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4160 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4161 return ICS; 4162 4163 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4164 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4165 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4166 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4167 return ICS; 4168 4169 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4170 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4171 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4172 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4173 // underlying type of the reference according to 4174 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4175 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4176 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4177 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4178 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4179 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4180 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4181 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4182 /*CStyle=*/false, 4183 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 4184 4185 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4186 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4187 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4188 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4189 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4190 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4191 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4192 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4193 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4194 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues. 4195 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4196 if (const ReferenceType *RefType 4197 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType() 4198 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 4199 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) { 4200 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, 4201 DeclType); 4202 return ICS; 4203 } 4204 } 4205 } 4206 4207 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4208 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4209 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4210 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true; 4211 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4212 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4213 } 4214 4215 return ICS; 4216} 4217 4218static ImplicitConversionSequence 4219TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4220 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4221 bool InOverloadResolution, 4222 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4223 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4224 4225/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4226/// initializer list From. 4227static ImplicitConversionSequence 4228TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4229 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4230 bool InOverloadResolution, 4231 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4232 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 4233 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 4234 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 4235 4236 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 4237 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 4238 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 4239 4240 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 4241 // initialized from init lists. 4242 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag())) 4243 return Result; 4244 4245 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 4246 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 4247 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 4248 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 4249 // element of the list to X. 4250 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 4251 QualType X; 4252 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 4253 X = S.Context.getBaseElementType(ToType); 4254 else 4255 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 4256 if (!X.isNull()) { 4257 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 4258 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 4259 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4260 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 4261 InOverloadResolution, 4262 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4263 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 4264 if (ICS.isBad()) { 4265 Result = ICS; 4266 break; 4267 } 4268 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 4269 if (Result.isBad() || 4270 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) == 4271 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4272 Result = ICS; 4273 } 4274 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 4275 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 4276 return Result; 4277 } 4278 4279 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 4280 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 4281 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 4282 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 4283 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 4284 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4285 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4286 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 4287 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4288 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4289 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 4290 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4291 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 4292 return Result; 4293 } 4294 4295 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 4296 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 4297 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 4298 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4299 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4300 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 4301 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 4302 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 4303 InitializedEntity Entity = 4304 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4305 /*Consumed=*/false); 4306 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) { 4307 Result.setUserDefined(); 4308 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4309 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 4310 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 4311 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 4312 4313 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4314 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 4315 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4316 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0; 4317 } 4318 return Result; 4319 } 4320 4321 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 4322 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 4323 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 4324 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 4325 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 4326 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 4327 4328 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4329 4330 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 4331 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 4332 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4333 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 4334 4335 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4336 4337 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4338 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4339 // type of the resulting function. 4340 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4341 DeclAccessPair Found; 4342 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 4343 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 4344 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4345 } 4346 4347 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4348 bool dummy1 = false; 4349 bool dummy2 = false; 4350 bool dummy3 = false; 4351 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4352 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1, 4353 dummy2, dummy3); 4354 4355 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) 4356 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, 4357 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 4358 SuppressUserConversions, 4359 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 4360 } 4361 4362 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 4363 // initializer list. 4364 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4365 InOverloadResolution, 4366 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4367 if (Result.isFailure()) 4368 return Result; 4369 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 4370 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 4371 4372 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 4373 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 4374 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 4375 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 4376 Result.UserDefined.After; 4377 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 4378 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 4379 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 4380 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4381 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4382 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4383 } else 4384 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 4385 From, ToType); 4386 return Result; 4387 } 4388 4389 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 4390 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 4391 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 4392 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion 4393 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the 4394 // parameter type. 4395 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 4396 if (NumInits == 1) 4397 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4398 SuppressUserConversions, 4399 InOverloadResolution, 4400 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4401 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 4402 // sequence is the identity conversion. 4403 else if (NumInits == 0) { 4404 Result.setStandard(); 4405 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4406 } 4407 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 4408 return Result; 4409 } 4410 4411 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 4412 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 4413 return Result; 4414} 4415 4416/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 4417/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 4418/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 4419/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 4420/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 4421/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 4422static ImplicitConversionSequence 4423TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4424 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4425 bool InOverloadResolution, 4426 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4427 bool AllowExplicit) { 4428 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 4429 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4430 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4431 4432 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 4433 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 4434 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 4435 SuppressUserConversions, 4436 AllowExplicit); 4437 4438 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 4439 SuppressUserConversions, 4440 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4441 InOverloadResolution, 4442 /*CStyle=*/false, 4443 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4444} 4445 4446static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 4447 const CanQualType ToQTy, 4448 Sema &S, 4449 SourceLocation Loc, 4450 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 4451 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 4452 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4453 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 4454 4455 return !ICS.isBad(); 4456} 4457 4458/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 4459/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 4460/// expression @p From. 4461static ImplicitConversionSequence 4462TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType, 4463 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 4464 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 4465 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 4466 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 4467 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 4468 // const volatile object. 4469 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ? 4470 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers(); 4471 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 4472 4473 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 4474 // to exit early. 4475 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4476 4477 // We need to have an object of class type. 4478 QualType FromType = OrigFromType; 4479 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4480 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 4481 4482 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 4483 // better have an lvalue. 4484 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 4485 } 4486 4487 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 4488 4489 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 4490 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 4491 // parameter is 4492 // 4493 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 4494 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 4495 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 4496 // ref-qualifier 4497 // 4498 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 4499 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 4500 // 4501 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 4502 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions 4503 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 4504 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 4505 // non-constant references. 4506 4507 // First check the qualifiers. 4508 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 4509 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 4510 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 4511 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 4512 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 4513 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType); 4514 return ICS; 4515 } 4516 4517 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 4518 // affects the conversion rank. 4519 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 4520 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 4521 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 4522 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 4523 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType)) 4524 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 4525 else { 4526 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 4527 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 4528 return ICS; 4529 } 4530 4531 // Check the ref-qualifier. 4532 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 4533 case RQ_None: 4534 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 4535 break; 4536 4537 case RQ_LValue: 4538 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) { 4539 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 4540 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 4541 ImplicitParamType); 4542 return ICS; 4543 } 4544 break; 4545 4546 case RQ_RValue: 4547 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 4548 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 4549 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 4550 ImplicitParamType); 4551 return ICS; 4552 } 4553 break; 4554 } 4555 4556 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 4557 ICS.setStandard(); 4558 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4559 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 4560 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 4561 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 4562 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4563 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 4564 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 4565 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4566 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 4567 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 4568 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 4569 return ICS; 4570} 4571 4572/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 4573/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 4574/// expression. 4575ExprResult 4576Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 4577 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 4578 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 4579 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 4580 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 4581 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 4582 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4583 4584 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 4585 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4586 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 4587 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 4588 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 4589 } else { 4590 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 4591 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 4592 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 4593 } 4594 4595 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 4596 // the actual argument initialization. 4597 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 4598 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification, 4599 Method, Method->getParent()); 4600 if (ICS.isBad()) { 4601 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) { 4602 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 4603 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 4604 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 4605 if (CVR) { 4606 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4607 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 4608 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 4609 << From->getSourceRange(); 4610 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 4611 << Method->getDeclName(); 4612 return ExprError(); 4613 } 4614 } 4615 4616 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4617 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init) 4618 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange(); 4619 } 4620 4621 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4622 ExprResult FromRes = 4623 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 4624 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 4625 return ExprError(); 4626 From = FromRes.take(); 4627 } 4628 4629 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) 4630 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp, 4631 From->getValueKind()).take(); 4632 return Owned(From); 4633} 4634 4635/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 4636/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 4637static ImplicitConversionSequence 4638TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 4639 // FIXME: This is pretty broken. 4640 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 4641 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 4642 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 4643 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 4644 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4645 /*CStyle=*/false, 4646 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 4647} 4648 4649/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 4650/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 4651ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 4652 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 4653 return ExprError(); 4654 4655 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 4656 if (!ICS.isBad()) 4657 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 4658 4659 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 4660 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4661 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 4662 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 4663 return ExprError(); 4664} 4665 4666/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 4667/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 4668/// is acceptable. 4669static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 4670 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 4671 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 4672 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 4673 // conversions are fine. 4674 switch (SCS.Second) { 4675 case ICK_Identity: 4676 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 4677 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 4678 return true; 4679 4680 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 4681 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 4682 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral 4683 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression. 4684 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 4685 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 4686 4687 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 4688 case ICK_Complex_Real: 4689 return false; 4690 4691 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 4692 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 4693 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 4694 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment: 4695 case ICK_Qualification: 4696 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 4697 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 4698 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 4699 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 4700 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 4701 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 4702 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 4703 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 4704 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 4705 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 4706 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 4707 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 4708 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 4709 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind"); 4710 4711 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 4712 break; 4713 } 4714 4715 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 4716} 4717 4718/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 4719/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 4720/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 4721ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 4722 llvm::APSInt &Value, 4723 CCEKind CCE) { 4724 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus0x && "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 4725 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 4726 4727 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 4728 return ExprError(); 4729 4730 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes: 4731 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression, 4732 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted 4733 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion 4734 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue 4735 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than 4736 // narrowing conversions. 4737 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4738 TryImplicitConversion(From, T, 4739 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 4740 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4741 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4742 /*CStyle=*/false, 4743 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false); 4744 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0; 4745 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 4746 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 4747 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard)) 4748 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4749 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 4750 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 4751 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 4752 break; 4753 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 4754 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so 4755 // the Before sequence must be trivial. 4756 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After)) 4757 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4758 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 4759 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 4760 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 4761 break; 4762 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 4763 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 4764 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 4765 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4766 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 4767 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 4768 return ExprError(); 4769 4770 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 4771 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 4772 } 4773 4774 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting); 4775 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4776 return Result; 4777 4778 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 4779 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 4780 bool Diagnosed = false; 4781 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue)) { 4782 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 4783 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 4784 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 4785 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 4786 break; 4787 4788 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 4789 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_cce_narrowing) 4790 << CCE << /*Constant*/1 4791 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, QualType()) << T; 4792 Diagnosed = true; 4793 break; 4794 4795 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 4796 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_cce_narrowing) 4797 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T; 4798 Diagnosed = true; 4799 break; 4800 } 4801 4802 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 4803 llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 4804 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 4805 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 4806 4807 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) { 4808 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 4809 // the AST. 4810 Result = ExprError(); 4811 } else { 4812 Value = Eval.Val.getInt(); 4813 4814 if (Notes.empty()) { 4815 // It's a constant expression. 4816 return Result; 4817 } 4818 } 4819 4820 // Only issue one narrowing diagnostic. 4821 if (Diagnosed) 4822 return Result; 4823 4824 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 4825 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 4826 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 4827 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 4828 else { 4829 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 4830 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 4831 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 4832 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 4833 } 4834 return Result; 4835} 4836 4837/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 4838/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 4839/// the result type of the conversion sequence. 4840static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 4841 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4842 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 4843 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 4844 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 4845 } 4846} 4847 4848/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 4849/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 4850static ImplicitConversionSequence 4851TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 4852 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 4853 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 4854 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 4855 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 4856 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 4857 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 4858 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 4859 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4860 /*CStyle=*/false, 4861 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 4862 4863 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 4864 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 4865 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 4866 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 4867 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 4868 break; 4869 4870 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 4871 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 4872 break; 4873 4874 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 4875 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 4876 break; 4877 } 4878 4879 return ICS; 4880} 4881 4882/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 4883/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 4884ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 4885 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 4886 return ExprError(); 4887 4888 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 4889 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4890 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 4891 if (!ICS.isBad()) 4892 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 4893 return ExprError(); 4894} 4895 4896/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 4897/// type of a permitted flavor. 4898static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) { 4899 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 4900 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 4901} 4902 4903/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or 4904/// enumeration type. 4905/// 4906/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an 4907/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single 4908/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 4909/// 4910/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 4911/// conversion. 4912/// 4913/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from. 4914/// 4915/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not 4916/// have integral or enumeration type. 4917/// 4918/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has 4919/// incomplete class type. 4920/// 4921/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an 4922/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions 4923/// were available). This is a recovery mode. 4924/// 4925/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag, 4926/// showing which conversion was picked. 4927/// 4928/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one 4929/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type. 4930/// 4931/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each 4932/// usable conversion function. 4933/// 4934/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion 4935/// function, which may be an extension in this case. 4936/// 4937/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped 4938/// enumerations should be considered. 4939/// 4940/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 4941/// successful. 4942ExprResult 4943Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 4944 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag, 4945 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag, 4946 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag, 4947 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote, 4948 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag, 4949 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote, 4950 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag, 4951 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) { 4952 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 4953 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 4954 return Owned(From); 4955 4956 // Process placeholders immediately. 4957 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 4958 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 4959 if (result.isInvalid()) return result; 4960 From = result.take(); 4961 } 4962 4963 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden. 4964 QualType T = From->getType(); 4965 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations)) 4966 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 4967 4968 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 4969 4970 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an 4971 // expression of integral or enumeration type. 4972 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 4973 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) { 4974 if (NotIntDiag.getDiagID()) 4975 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) << T << From->getSourceRange(); 4976 return Owned(From); 4977 } 4978 4979 // We must have a complete class type. 4980 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag)) 4981 return Owned(From); 4982 4983 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 4984 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions; 4985 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 4986 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 4987 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4988 4989 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1); 4990 4991 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 4992 E = Conversions->end(); 4993 I != E; 4994 ++I) { 4995 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 4996 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) { 4997 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType( 4998 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(), 4999 AllowScopedEnumerations)) { 5000 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) 5001 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5002 else 5003 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5004 } 5005 } 5006 } 5007 5008 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 5009 case 0: 5010 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && ExplicitConvDiag.getDiagID()) { 5011 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5012 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 5013 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5014 5015 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5016 // conversion; use it. 5017 QualType ConvTy 5018 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5019 std::string TypeStr; 5020 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy()); 5021 5022 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag) 5023 << T << ConvTy 5024 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(), 5025 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5026 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), 5027 ")"); 5028 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote) 5029 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 5030 5031 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5032 // explicit conversion function. 5033 if (isSFINAEContext()) 5034 return ExprError(); 5035 5036 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found); 5037 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5038 HadMultipleCandidates); 5039 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5040 return ExprError(); 5041 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5042 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5043 CK_UserDefinedConversion, 5044 Result.get(), 0, 5045 Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5046 } 5047 5048 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5049 break; 5050 5051 case 1: { 5052 // Apply this conversion. 5053 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 5054 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found); 5055 5056 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 5057 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5058 QualType ConvTy 5059 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5060 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) { 5061 if (isSFINAEContext()) 5062 return ExprError(); 5063 5064 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag) 5065 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange(); 5066 } 5067 5068 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5069 HadMultipleCandidates); 5070 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5071 return ExprError(); 5072 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5073 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5074 CK_UserDefinedConversion, 5075 Result.get(), 0, 5076 Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5077 break; 5078 } 5079 5080 default: 5081 if (!AmbigDiag.getDiagID()) 5082 return Owned(From); 5083 5084 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag) 5085 << T << From->getSourceRange(); 5086 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5087 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 5088 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5089 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5090 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote) 5091 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 5092 } 5093 return Owned(From); 5094 } 5095 5096 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) && 5097 NotIntDiag.getDiagID()) 5098 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5099 5100 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5101} 5102 5103/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 5104/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 5105/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 5106/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 5107/// 5108/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 5109/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 5110/// code completion. 5111void 5112Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, 5113 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5114 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5115 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5116 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5117 bool PartialOverloading, 5118 bool AllowExplicit) { 5119 const FunctionProtoType* Proto 5120 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 5121 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 5122 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 5123 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 5124 5125 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 5126 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 5127 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 5128 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 5129 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 5130 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 5131 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 5132 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 5133 // is irrelevant. 5134 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), 5135 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), 5136 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 5137 return; 5138 } 5139 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 5140 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 5141 } 5142 5143 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function)) 5144 return; 5145 5146 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5147 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 5148 5149 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){ 5150 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 5151 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 5152 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 5153 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 5154 if (Args.size() == 1 && 5155 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 5156 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 5157 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType))) 5158 return; 5159 } 5160 5161 // Add this candidate 5162 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 5163 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5164 Candidate.Function = Function; 5165 Candidate.Viable = true; 5166 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5167 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5168 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5169 5170 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 5171 5172 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 5173 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 5174 // list (8.3.5). 5175 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto && 5176 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 5177 Candidate.Viable = false; 5178 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 5179 return; 5180 } 5181 5182 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 5183 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 5184 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 5185 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 5186 // exactly m parameters. 5187 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 5188 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 5189 // Not enough arguments. 5190 Candidate.Viable = false; 5191 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 5192 return; 5193 } 5194 5195 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 5196 if (getLangOptions().CUDA) 5197 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 5198 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) { 5199 Candidate.Viable = false; 5200 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 5201 return; 5202 } 5203 5204 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 5205 // arguments. 5206 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 5207 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 5208 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 5209 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 5210 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 5211 // parameter of F. 5212 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 5213 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 5214 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 5215 SuppressUserConversions, 5216 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 5217 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 5218 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount, 5219 AllowExplicit); 5220 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 5221 Candidate.Viable = false; 5222 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5223 break; 5224 } 5225 } else { 5226 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 5227 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 5228 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 5229 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis(); 5230 } 5231 } 5232} 5233 5234/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 5235/// the overload canddiate set. 5236void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 5237 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5238 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5239 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5240 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 5241 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 5242 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5243 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 5244 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) 5245 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 5246 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), 5247 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context), 5248 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet, 5249 SuppressUserConversions); 5250 else 5251 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet, 5252 SuppressUserConversions); 5253 } else { 5254 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 5255 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) && 5256 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic()) 5257 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 5258 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 5259 ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5260 Args[0]->getType(), 5261 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 5262 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 5263 else 5264 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 5265 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 5266 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 5267 } 5268 } 5269} 5270 5271/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 5272/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 5273void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5274 QualType ObjectType, 5275 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 5276 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 5277 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5278 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 5279 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5280 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 5281 5282 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 5283 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 5284 5285 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 5286 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 5287 "Expected a member function template"); 5288 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 5289 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 5290 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 5291 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet, 5292 SuppressUserConversions); 5293 } else { 5294 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 5295 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 5296 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 5297 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 5298 } 5299} 5300 5301/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 5302/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 5303/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 5304/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 5305/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 5306/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 5307/// operators. 5308void 5309Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5310 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 5311 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 5312 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5313 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5314 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 5315 const FunctionProtoType* Proto 5316 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 5317 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 5318 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 5319 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 5320 5321 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method)) 5322 return; 5323 5324 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5325 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 5326 5327 // Add this candidate 5328 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 5329 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5330 Candidate.Function = Method; 5331 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5332 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5333 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5334 5335 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 5336 5337 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 5338 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 5339 // list (8.3.5). 5340 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 5341 Candidate.Viable = false; 5342 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 5343 return; 5344 } 5345 5346 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 5347 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 5348 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 5349 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 5350 // exactly m parameters. 5351 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 5352 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) { 5353 // Not enough arguments. 5354 Candidate.Viable = false; 5355 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 5356 return; 5357 } 5358 5359 Candidate.Viable = true; 5360 5361 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 5362 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 5363 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 5364 else { 5365 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 5366 // parameter. 5367 Candidate.Conversions[0] 5368 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 5369 Method, ActingContext); 5370 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 5371 Candidate.Viable = false; 5372 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5373 return; 5374 } 5375 } 5376 5377 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 5378 // arguments. 5379 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 5380 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 5381 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 5382 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 5383 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 5384 // parameter of F. 5385 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 5386 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 5387 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 5388 SuppressUserConversions, 5389 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 5390 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 5391 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount); 5392 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 5393 Candidate.Viable = false; 5394 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5395 break; 5396 } 5397 } else { 5398 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 5399 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 5400 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 5401 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 5402 } 5403 } 5404} 5405 5406/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 5407/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 5408/// function template specialization. 5409void 5410Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, 5411 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5412 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 5413 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5414 QualType ObjectType, 5415 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 5416 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5417 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5418 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 5419 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl)) 5420 return; 5421 5422 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 5423 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 5424 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 5425 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 5426 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 5427 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 5428 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 5429 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 5430 // functions. 5431 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 5432 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 5433 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 5434 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 5435 Specialization, Info)) { 5436 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 5437 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5438 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 5439 Candidate.Viable = false; 5440 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 5441 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5442 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5443 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5444 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 5445 Info); 5446 return; 5447 } 5448 5449 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 5450 // deduction as a candidate. 5451 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 5452 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 5453 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 5454 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 5455 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 5456 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 5457} 5458 5459/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 5460/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 5461/// an appropriate function template specialization. 5462void 5463Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 5464 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5465 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5466 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5467 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5468 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 5469 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 5470 return; 5471 5472 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 5473 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 5474 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 5475 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 5476 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 5477 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 5478 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 5479 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 5480 // functions. 5481 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 5482 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 5483 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 5484 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 5485 Specialization, Info)) { 5486 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 5487 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5488 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 5489 Candidate.Viable = false; 5490 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 5491 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5492 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5493 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5494 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 5495 Info); 5496 return; 5497 } 5498 5499 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 5500 // deduction as a candidate. 5501 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 5502 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 5503 SuppressUserConversions); 5504} 5505 5506/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 5507/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 5508/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 5509/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 5510/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 5511/// conversion function produces). 5512void 5513Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 5514 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5515 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 5516 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5517 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 5518 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 5519 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 5520 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5521 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 5522 return; 5523 5524 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5525 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 5526 5527 // Add this candidate 5528 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 5529 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5530 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 5531 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5532 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5533 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5534 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 5535 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5536 Candidate.Viable = true; 5537 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 5538 5539 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 5540 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 5541 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 5542 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 5543 // 5544 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 5545 // object parameter. 5546 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 5547 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 5548 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 5549 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 5550 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 5551 5552 Candidate.Conversions[0] 5553 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), 5554 From->Classify(Context), 5555 Conversion, ConversionContext); 5556 5557 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 5558 Candidate.Viable = false; 5559 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5560 return; 5561 } 5562 5563 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a 5564 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 5565 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 5566 QualType FromCanon 5567 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 5568 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 5569 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 5570 Candidate.Viable = false; 5571 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 5572 return; 5573 } 5574 5575 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 5576 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 5577 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 5578 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 5579 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 5580 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 5581 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 5582 // well-formed. 5583 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(), 5584 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart()); 5585 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 5586 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 5587 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 5588 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 5589 5590 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 5591 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) { 5592 Candidate.Viable = false; 5593 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 5594 return; 5595 } 5596 5597 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 5598 5599 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 5600 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 5601 // allocator). 5602 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 5603 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK, 5604 From->getLocStart()); 5605 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5606 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType, 5607 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 5608 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5609 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 5610 5611 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5612 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5613 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 5614 5615 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 5616 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 5617 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 5618 // shall have exact match rank. 5619 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 5620 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 5621 Candidate.Viable = false; 5622 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 5623 } 5624 5625 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 5626 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 5627 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 5628 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 5629 // program is ill-formed. 5630 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 5631 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 5632 Candidate.Viable = false; 5633 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 5634 } 5635 break; 5636 5637 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5638 Candidate.Viable = false; 5639 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 5640 break; 5641 5642 default: 5643 llvm_unreachable( 5644 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 5645 } 5646} 5647 5648/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization 5649/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 5650/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 5651/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 5652/// [temp.deduct.conv]). 5653void 5654Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 5655 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5656 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, 5657 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5658 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5659 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 5660 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 5661 5662 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 5663 return; 5664 5665 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 5666 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0; 5667 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 5668 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 5669 Specialization, Info)) { 5670 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 5671 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5672 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 5673 Candidate.Viable = false; 5674 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 5675 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5676 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5677 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 5678 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 5679 Info); 5680 return; 5681 } 5682 5683 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 5684 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 5685 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 5686 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 5687 CandidateSet); 5688} 5689 5690/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 5691/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 5692/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 5693/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 5694/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 5695void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 5696 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5697 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 5698 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 5699 Expr *Object, 5700 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5701 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 5702 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 5703 return; 5704 5705 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5706 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 5707 5708 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 5709 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5710 Candidate.Function = 0; 5711 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 5712 Candidate.Viable = true; 5713 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 5714 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5715 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5716 5717 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 5718 // object parameter. 5719 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit 5720 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(), 5721 Object->Classify(Context), 5722 Conversion, ActingContext); 5723 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 5724 Candidate.Viable = false; 5725 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5726 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 5727 return; 5728 } 5729 5730 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 5731 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 5732 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 5733 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 5734 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 5735 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 5736 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 5737 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 5738 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 5739 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 5740 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 5741 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5742 5743 // Find the 5744 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 5745 5746 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 5747 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 5748 // list (8.3.5). 5749 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 5750 Candidate.Viable = false; 5751 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 5752 return; 5753 } 5754 5755 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 5756 // we have enough arguments. 5757 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) { 5758 // Not enough arguments. 5759 Candidate.Viable = false; 5760 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 5761 return; 5762 } 5763 5764 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 5765 // arguments. 5766 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 5767 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 5768 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 5769 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 5770 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 5771 // parameter of F. 5772 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 5773 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 5774 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 5775 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5776 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5777 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 5778 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount); 5779 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 5780 Candidate.Viable = false; 5781 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5782 break; 5783 } 5784 } else { 5785 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 5786 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 5787 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 5788 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 5789 } 5790 } 5791} 5792 5793/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 5794/// member functions. 5795/// 5796/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 5797/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 5798/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 5799/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 5800/// [over.match.oper]). 5801void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 5802 SourceLocation OpLoc, 5803 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 5804 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5805 SourceRange OpRange) { 5806 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 5807 5808 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 5809 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 5810 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 5811 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 5812 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 5813 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 5814 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 5815 // constructed as follows: 5816 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 5817 5818 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the 5819 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@ 5820 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is 5821 // empty. 5822 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 5823 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done. 5824 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag())) 5825 return; 5826 5827 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 5828 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 5829 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 5830 5831 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 5832 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 5833 Oper != OperEnd; 5834 ++Oper) 5835 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 5836 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, 5837 CandidateSet, 5838 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false); 5839 } 5840} 5841 5842/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 5843/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 5844/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 5845/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 5846/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 5847/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 5848/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 5849/// converted to bool. 5850void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys, 5851 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 5852 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5853 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 5854 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 5855 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5856 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 5857 5858 // Add this candidate 5859 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs); 5860 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none); 5861 Candidate.Function = 0; 5862 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5863 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5864 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy; 5865 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 5866 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx]; 5867 5868 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 5869 // arguments. 5870 Candidate.Viable = true; 5871 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs; 5872 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 5873 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 5874 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 5875 // left operand are restricted as follows: 5876 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 5877 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 5878 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 5879 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 5880 // 5881 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 5882 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 5883 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 5884 // is not of the same type. 5885 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 5886 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 5887 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 5888 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 5889 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 5890 } else { 5891 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 5892 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 5893 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 5894 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5895 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 5896 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount); 5897 } 5898 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 5899 Candidate.Viable = false; 5900 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5901 break; 5902 } 5903 } 5904} 5905 5906/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 5907/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 5908/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 5909/// enumeration types. 5910class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 5911 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 5912 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet; 5913 5914 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 5915 /// built-in candidates. 5916 TypeSet PointerTypes; 5917 5918 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 5919 /// used in the built-in candidates. 5920 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 5921 5922 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 5923 /// used in the built-in candidates. 5924 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 5925 5926 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 5927 /// candidates. 5928 TypeSet VectorTypes; 5929 5930 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 5931 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 5932 5933 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 5934 /// were present in the candidate set. 5935 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 5936 5937 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 5938 /// candidate set. 5939 bool HasNullPtrType; 5940 5941 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 5942 /// candidate type set. 5943 Sema &SemaRef; 5944 5945 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 5946 ASTContext &Context; 5947 5948 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 5949 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 5950 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 5951 5952public: 5953 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 5954 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 5955 5956 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 5957 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 5958 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 5959 HasNullPtrType(false), 5960 SemaRef(SemaRef), 5961 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 5962 5963 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 5964 SourceLocation Loc, 5965 bool AllowUserConversions, 5966 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 5967 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 5968 5969 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 5970 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 5971 5972 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 5973 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 5974 5975 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 5976 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 5977 5978 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 5979 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 5980 5981 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 5982 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 5983 5984 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 5985 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 5986 5987 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 5988 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 5989 5990 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 5991 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 5992 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 5993}; 5994 5995/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 5996/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 5997/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 5998/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 5999/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 6000/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 6001/// false otherwise. 6002/// 6003/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 6004bool 6005BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 6006 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 6007 6008 // Insert this type. 6009 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 6010 return false; 6011 6012 QualType PointeeTy; 6013 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 6014 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 6015 if (!PointerTy) { 6016 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 6017 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6018 buildObjCPtr = true; 6019 } 6020 else 6021 llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!"); 6022 } 6023 else 6024 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 6025 6026 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 6027 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 6028 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 6029 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 6030 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 6031 return true; 6032 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 6033 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy)) 6034 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers(); 6035 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 6036 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 6037 6038 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 6039 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 6040 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 6041 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere 6042 // in the types. 6043 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 6044 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue; 6045 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 6046 if (!buildObjCPtr) 6047 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy)); 6048 else 6049 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy)); 6050 } 6051 6052 return true; 6053} 6054 6055/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 6056/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 6057/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 6058/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 6059/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 6060/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 6061/// false otherwise. 6062/// 6063/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 6064bool 6065BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 6066 QualType Ty) { 6067 // Insert this type. 6068 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 6069 return false; 6070 6071 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 6072 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 6073 6074 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 6075 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 6076 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 6077 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 6078 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 6079 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 6080 return true; 6081 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 6082 6083 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 6084 // qualifiers. 6085 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 6086 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 6087 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 6088 6089 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 6090 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 6091 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 6092 } 6093 6094 return true; 6095} 6096 6097/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 6098/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 6099/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 6100/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 6101/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 6102/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 6103/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 6104/// type. 6105void 6106BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 6107 SourceLocation Loc, 6108 bool AllowUserConversions, 6109 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6110 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 6111 // Only deal with canonical types. 6112 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 6113 6114 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 6115 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 6116 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 6117 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 6118 6119 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 6120 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 6121 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 6122 6123 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 6124 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 6125 6126 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 6127 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 6128 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 6129 6130 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 6131 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 6132 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 6133 6134 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 6135 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 6136 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 6137 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 6138 // of types. 6139 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 6140 return; 6141 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 6142 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 6143 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 6144 return; 6145 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 6146 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 6147 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 6148 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 6149 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 6150 // extension. 6151 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 6152 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 6153 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 6154 HasNullPtrType = true; 6155 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 6156 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 6157 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0)) 6158 return; 6159 6160 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 6161 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 6162 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 6163 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 6164 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 6165 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl(); 6166 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 6167 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 6168 6169 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 6170 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 6171 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 6172 continue; 6173 6174 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6175 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 6176 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 6177 VisibleQuals); 6178 } 6179 } 6180 } 6181} 6182 6183/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 6184/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 6185/// given type to the candidate set. 6186static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 6187 QualType T, 6188 Expr **Args, 6189 unsigned NumArgs, 6190 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 6191 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 6192 6193 // T& operator=(T&, T) 6194 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 6195 ParamTypes[1] = T; 6196 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 6197 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 6198 6199 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 6200 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 6201 ParamTypes[0] 6202 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T)); 6203 ParamTypes[1] = T; 6204 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 6205 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 6206 } 6207} 6208 6209/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 6210/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 6211static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 6212 Qualifiers VRQuals; 6213 const RecordType *TyRec; 6214 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 6215 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 6216 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 6217 else 6218 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 6219 if (!TyRec) { 6220 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 6221 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 6222 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 6223 return VRQuals; 6224 } 6225 6226 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 6227 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 6228 return VRQuals; 6229 6230 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions = 6231 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 6232 6233 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 6234 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 6235 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl(); 6236 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 6237 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 6238 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 6239 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 6240 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 6241 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 6242 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 6243 // as see them. 6244 bool done = false; 6245 while (!done) { 6246 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 6247 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 6248 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 6249 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 6250 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 6251 else 6252 done = true; 6253 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 6254 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 6255 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 6256 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 6257 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 6258 return VRQuals; 6259 } 6260 } 6261 } 6262 return VRQuals; 6263} 6264 6265namespace { 6266 6267/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 6268/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 6269/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 6270/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 6271class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 6272 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 6273 Sema &S; 6274 Expr **Args; 6275 unsigned NumArgs; 6276 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 6277 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 6278 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 6279 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 6280 6281 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types 6282 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below. 6283 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 6284 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 6285 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3; 6286 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18; 6287 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3, 6288 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9; 6289 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0, 6290 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9; 6291 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18; 6292 6293 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index. 6294 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) { 6295 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes); 6296 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const 6297 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = { 6298 // Start of promoted types. 6299 &ASTContext::FloatTy, 6300 &ASTContext::DoubleTy, 6301 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy, 6302 6303 // Start of integral types. 6304 &ASTContext::IntTy, 6305 &ASTContext::LongTy, 6306 &ASTContext::LongLongTy, 6307 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy, 6308 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy, 6309 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy, 6310 // End of promoted types. 6311 6312 &ASTContext::BoolTy, 6313 &ASTContext::CharTy, 6314 &ASTContext::WCharTy, 6315 &ASTContext::Char16Ty, 6316 &ASTContext::Char32Ty, 6317 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy, 6318 &ASTContext::ShortTy, 6319 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy, 6320 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy, 6321 // End of integral types. 6322 // FIXME: What about complex? 6323 }; 6324 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index]; 6325 } 6326 6327 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic 6328 /// converions for the given arithmetic types. 6329 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) { 6330 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions. 6331 // The rules are basically: 6332 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point 6333 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank 6334 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank 6335 // - use the larger type 6336 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are 6337 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results 6338 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank. 6339 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's 6340 // better not to make any assumptions). 6341 enum PromotedType { 6342 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1 6343 }; 6344 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType] 6345 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = { 6346 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt }, 6347 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl }, 6348 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl }, 6349 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL }, 6350 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL }, 6351 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL }, 6352 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL }, 6353 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL }, 6354 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL }, 6355 }; 6356 6357 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 6358 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 6359 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R]; 6360 6361 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer. 6362 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx); 6363 6364 // Slow path: we need to compare widths. 6365 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank. 6366 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L), 6367 RT = getArithmeticType(R); 6368 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT), 6369 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT); 6370 6371 // If they're different widths, use the signed type. 6372 if (LW > RW) return LT; 6373 else if (LW < RW) return RT; 6374 6375 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank. 6376 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy; 6377 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL); 6378 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 6379 } 6380 6381 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 6382 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 6383 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 6384 bool HasVolatile) { 6385 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 6386 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 6387 S.Context.IntTy 6388 }; 6389 6390 // Non-volatile version. 6391 if (NumArgs == 1) 6392 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6393 else 6394 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 6395 6396 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 6397 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 6398 if (HasVolatile) { 6399 ParamTypes[0] = 6400 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 6401 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 6402 if (NumArgs == 1) 6403 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6404 else 6405 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 6406 } 6407 } 6408 6409public: 6410 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 6411 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 6412 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 6413 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 6414 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 6415 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 6416 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs), 6417 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 6418 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 6419 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 6420 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 6421 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 6422 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds. 6423 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy && 6424 "Invalid first promoted integral type"); 6425 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1) 6426 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy && 6427 "Invalid last promoted integral type"); 6428 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType) 6429 == S.Context.FloatTy && 6430 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type"); 6431 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1) 6432 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy && 6433 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type"); 6434 } 6435 6436 // C++ [over.built]p3: 6437 // 6438 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ 6439 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator 6440 // functions of the form 6441 // 6442 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 6443 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 6444 // 6445 // C++ [over.built]p4: 6446 // 6447 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 6448 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 6449 // candidate operator functions of the form 6450 // 6451 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 6452 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 6453 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 6454 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 6455 return; 6456 6457 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1); 6458 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 6459 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 6460 getArithmeticType(Arith), 6461 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()); 6462 } 6463 } 6464 6465 // C++ [over.built]p5: 6466 // 6467 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 6468 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 6469 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 6470 // 6471 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 6472 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 6473 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 6474 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 6475 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 6476 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6477 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 6478 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 6479 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6480 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 6481 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 6482 continue; 6483 6484 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 6485 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 6486 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile())); 6487 } 6488 } 6489 6490 // C++ [over.built]p6: 6491 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 6492 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 6493 // 6494 // T& operator*(T*); 6495 // 6496 // C++ [over.built]p7: 6497 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 6498 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 6499 // T& operator*(T*); 6500 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 6501 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6502 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 6503 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 6504 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6505 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 6506 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 6507 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 6508 continue; 6509 6510 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 6511 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 6512 continue; 6513 6514 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy), 6515 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6516 } 6517 } 6518 6519 // C++ [over.built]p9: 6520 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 6521 // operator functions of the form 6522 // 6523 // T operator+(T); 6524 // T operator-(T); 6525 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 6526 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 6527 return; 6528 6529 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 6530 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 6531 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith); 6532 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6533 } 6534 6535 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 6536 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6537 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 6538 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 6539 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 6540 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 6541 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6542 } 6543 } 6544 6545 // C++ [over.built]p8: 6546 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 6547 // the form 6548 // 6549 // T* operator+(T*); 6550 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 6551 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6552 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 6553 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 6554 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6555 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 6556 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6557 } 6558 } 6559 6560 // C++ [over.built]p10: 6561 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 6562 // operator functions of the form 6563 // 6564 // T operator~(T); 6565 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 6566 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 6567 return; 6568 6569 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 6570 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 6571 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int); 6572 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6573 } 6574 6575 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 6576 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6577 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 6578 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 6579 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 6580 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 6581 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 6582 } 6583 } 6584 6585 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 6586 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator 6587 // functions of the form 6588 // 6589 // bool operator==(T,T); 6590 // bool operator!=(T,T); 6591 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() { 6592 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 6593 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 6594 6595 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 6596 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6597 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 6598 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 6599 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 6600 ++MemPtr) { 6601 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 6602 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 6603 continue; 6604 6605 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 6606 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 6607 CandidateSet); 6608 } 6609 } 6610 } 6611 6612 // C++ [over.built]p15: 6613 // 6614 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or 6615 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 6616 // 6617 // bool operator<(T, T); 6618 // bool operator>(T, T); 6619 // bool operator<=(T, T); 6620 // bool operator>=(T, T); 6621 // bool operator==(T, T); 6622 // bool operator!=(T, T); 6623 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 6624 // C++ [over.built]p1: 6625 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter 6626 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator 6627 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate 6628 // functions. 6629 // 6630 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end 6631 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for 6632 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem, 6633 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the 6634 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=, 6635 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 6636 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 6637 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 6638 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 6639 6640 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 6641 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 6642 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 6643 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 6644 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 6645 C != CEnd; ++C) { 6646 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 6647 continue; 6648 6649 QualType FirstParamType = 6650 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 6651 QualType SecondParamType = 6652 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 6653 6654 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 6655 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 6656 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 6657 continue; 6658 6659 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 6660 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 6661 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 6662 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 6663 } 6664 } 6665 } 6666 6667 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 6668 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 6669 6670 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 6671 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6672 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 6673 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 6674 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6675 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 6676 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 6677 continue; 6678 6679 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 6680 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 6681 CandidateSet); 6682 } 6683 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6684 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 6685 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 6686 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 6687 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 6688 6689 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 6690 // candidate exists. 6691 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) || 6692 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 6693 CanonType))) 6694 continue; 6695 6696 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 6697 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 6698 CandidateSet); 6699 } 6700 6701 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 6702 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 6703 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) && 6704 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy, 6705 NullPtrTy))) { 6706 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 6707 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 6708 CandidateSet); 6709 } 6710 } 6711 } 6712 } 6713 6714 // C++ [over.built]p13: 6715 // 6716 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 6717 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 6718 // 6719 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 6720 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 6721 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 6722 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 6723 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 6724 // 6725 // C++ [over.built]p14: 6726 // 6727 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 6728 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 6729 // 6730 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 6731 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 6732 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 6733 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 6734 6735 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 6736 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = { 6737 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 6738 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 6739 }; 6740 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6741 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 6742 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 6743 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6744 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 6745 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 6746 continue; 6747 6748 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 6749 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 6750 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 6751 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 6752 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2, 6753 CandidateSet); 6754 } 6755 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 6756 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 6757 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 6758 continue; 6759 6760 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 6761 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes, 6762 Args, 2, CandidateSet); 6763 } 6764 } 6765 } 6766 } 6767 6768 // C++ [over.built]p12: 6769 // 6770 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 6771 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 6772 // 6773 // LR operator*(L, R); 6774 // LR operator/(L, R); 6775 // LR operator+(L, R); 6776 // LR operator-(L, R); 6777 // bool operator<(L, R); 6778 // bool operator>(L, R); 6779 // bool operator<=(L, R); 6780 // bool operator>=(L, R); 6781 // bool operator==(L, R); 6782 // bool operator!=(L, R); 6783 // 6784 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 6785 // between types L and R. 6786 // 6787 // C++ [over.built]p24: 6788 // 6789 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 6790 // candidate operator functions of the form 6791 // 6792 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 6793 // 6794 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 6795 // between types L and R. 6796 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 6797 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) { 6798 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 6799 return; 6800 6801 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 6802 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 6803 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 6804 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 6805 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 6806 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 6807 QualType Result = 6808 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy 6809 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right); 6810 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 6811 } 6812 } 6813 6814 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 6815 // conditional operator for vector types. 6816 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6817 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 6818 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 6819 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 6820 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6821 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 6822 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 6823 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 6824 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 6825 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy; 6826 if (!isComparison) { 6827 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType()) 6828 Result = *Vec1; 6829 else 6830 Result = *Vec2; 6831 } 6832 6833 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 6834 } 6835 } 6836 } 6837 6838 // C++ [over.built]p17: 6839 // 6840 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 6841 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 6842 // 6843 // LR operator%(L, R); 6844 // LR operator&(L, R); 6845 // LR operator^(L, R); 6846 // LR operator|(L, R); 6847 // L operator<<(L, R); 6848 // L operator>>(L, R); 6849 // 6850 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 6851 // between types L and R. 6852 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 6853 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 6854 return; 6855 6856 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 6857 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 6858 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 6859 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 6860 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 6861 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 6862 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater) 6863 ? LandR[0] 6864 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right); 6865 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 6866 } 6867 } 6868 } 6869 6870 // C++ [over.built]p20: 6871 // 6872 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 6873 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 6874 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 6875 // 6876 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 6877 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 6878 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 6879 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 6880 6881 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 6882 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6883 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 6884 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 6885 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 6886 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 6887 continue; 6888 6889 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2, 6890 CandidateSet); 6891 } 6892 6893 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6894 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 6895 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 6896 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 6897 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 6898 continue; 6899 6900 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2, 6901 CandidateSet); 6902 } 6903 } 6904 } 6905 6906 // C++ [over.built]p19: 6907 // 6908 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 6909 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 6910 // of the form 6911 // 6912 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 6913 // 6914 // C++ [over.built]p21: 6915 // 6916 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 6917 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 6918 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 6919 // 6920 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 6921 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 6922 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 6923 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 6924 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 6925 6926 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6927 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 6928 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 6929 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6930 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 6931 if (isEqualOp) 6932 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 6933 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 6934 continue; 6935 6936 // non-volatile version 6937 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 6938 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 6939 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 6940 }; 6941 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 6942 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 6943 6944 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 6945 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 6946 // volatile version 6947 ParamTypes[0] = 6948 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 6949 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 6950 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 6951 } 6952 } 6953 6954 if (isEqualOp) { 6955 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 6956 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 6957 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 6958 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 6959 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 6960 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 6961 continue; 6962 6963 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 6964 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 6965 *Ptr, 6966 }; 6967 6968 // non-volatile version 6969 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 6970 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 6971 6972 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 6973 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 6974 // volatile version 6975 ParamTypes[0] = 6976 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 6977 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 6978 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 6979 } 6980 } 6981 } 6982 } 6983 6984 // C++ [over.built]p18: 6985 // 6986 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 6987 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 6988 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 6989 // the form 6990 // 6991 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 6992 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 6993 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 6994 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 6995 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 6996 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 6997 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 6998 return; 6999 7000 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 7001 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7002 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 7003 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7004 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 7005 7006 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 7007 ParamTypes[0] = 7008 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 7009 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 7010 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7011 7012 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 7013 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 7014 ParamTypes[0] = 7015 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 7016 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 7017 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 7018 CandidateSet, 7019 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7020 } 7021 } 7022 } 7023 7024 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 7025 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7026 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7027 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7028 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 7029 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7030 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 7031 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 7032 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 7033 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7034 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 7035 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 7036 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 7037 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 7038 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7039 7040 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 7041 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 7042 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 7043 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 7044 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 7045 CandidateSet, 7046 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7047 } 7048 } 7049 } 7050 } 7051 7052 // C++ [over.built]p22: 7053 // 7054 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 7055 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 7056 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7057 // 7058 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 7059 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 7060 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 7061 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 7062 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 7063 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 7064 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 7065 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7066 return; 7067 7068 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 7069 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7070 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 7071 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7072 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 7073 7074 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 7075 ParamTypes[0] = 7076 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 7077 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7078 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 7079 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 7080 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left); 7081 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 7082 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 7083 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 7084 CandidateSet); 7085 } 7086 } 7087 } 7088 } 7089 7090 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 7091 // 7092 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 7093 // 7094 // bool operator!(bool); 7095 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 7096 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 7097 void addExclaimOverload() { 7098 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 7099 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet, 7100 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 7101 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 7102 } 7103 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 7104 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 7105 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 7106 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 7107 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 7108 } 7109 7110 // C++ [over.built]p13: 7111 // 7112 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 7113 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7114 // 7115 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 7116 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 7117 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 7118 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 7119 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 7120 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 7121 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7122 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7123 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7124 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7125 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 7126 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 7127 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 7128 continue; 7129 7130 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 7131 7132 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 7133 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7134 } 7135 7136 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7137 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 7138 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 7139 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7140 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 7141 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 7142 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 7143 continue; 7144 7145 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 7146 7147 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 7148 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7149 } 7150 } 7151 7152 // C++ [over.built]p11: 7153 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 7154 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 7155 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 7156 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7157 // 7158 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 7159 // 7160 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 7161 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 7162 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7163 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7164 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7165 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7166 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 7167 QualType C1; 7168 QualifierCollector Q1; 7169 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 7170 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 7171 continue; 7172 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 7173 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 7174 // volatile/restrict type. 7175 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 7176 continue; 7177 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 7178 continue; 7179 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7180 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 7181 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 7182 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 7183 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 7184 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 7185 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 7186 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2)) 7187 break; 7188 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 7189 // build CV12 T& 7190 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 7191 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 7192 T.isVolatileQualified()) 7193 continue; 7194 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 7195 T.isRestrictQualified()) 7196 continue; 7197 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 7198 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 7199 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7200 } 7201 } 7202 } 7203 7204 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 7205 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 7206 // therefore added as binary. 7207 // 7208 // C++ [over.built]p25: 7209 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 7210 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7211 // 7212 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 7213 // 7214 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 7215 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7216 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7217 7218 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 7219 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7220 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 7221 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 7222 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7223 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 7224 continue; 7225 7226 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 7227 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7228 } 7229 7230 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7231 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 7232 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 7233 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 7234 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 7235 continue; 7236 7237 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 7238 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7239 } 7240 7241 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) { 7242 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7243 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 7244 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 7245 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 7246 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 7247 continue; 7248 7249 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 7250 continue; 7251 7252 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 7253 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 7254 } 7255 } 7256 } 7257 } 7258}; 7259 7260} // end anonymous namespace 7261 7262/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 7263/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 7264/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 7265/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 7266/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 7267void 7268Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7269 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7270 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 7271 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7272 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 7273 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 7274 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 7275 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 7276 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 7277 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 7278 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 7279 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 7280 7281 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 7282 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 7283 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 7284 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 7285 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this)); 7286 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 7287 OpLoc, 7288 true, 7289 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 7290 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 7291 Op == OO_PipePipe), 7292 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7293 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 7294 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 7295 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 7296 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 7297 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 7298 } 7299 7300 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 7301 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 7302 // 7303 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 7304 // 'bool' overloads. 7305 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 7306 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 7307 return; 7308 7309 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 7310 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs, 7311 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 7312 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 7313 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 7314 7315 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 7316 switch (Op) { 7317 case OO_None: 7318 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 7319 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 7320 7321 case OO_New: 7322 case OO_Delete: 7323 case OO_Array_New: 7324 case OO_Array_Delete: 7325 case OO_Call: 7326 llvm_unreachable( 7327 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 7328 7329 case OO_Comma: 7330 case OO_Arrow: 7331 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7332 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 7333 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 7334 break; 7335 7336 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 7337 if (NumArgs == 1) 7338 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 7339 // Fall through. 7340 7341 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 7342 if (NumArgs == 1) { 7343 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 7344 } else { 7345 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 7346 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 7347 } 7348 break; 7349 7350 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 7351 if (NumArgs == 1) 7352 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 7353 else 7354 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 7355 break; 7356 7357 case OO_Slash: 7358 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 7359 break; 7360 7361 case OO_PlusPlus: 7362 case OO_MinusMinus: 7363 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 7364 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 7365 break; 7366 7367 case OO_EqualEqual: 7368 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 7369 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads(); 7370 // Fall through. 7371 7372 case OO_Less: 7373 case OO_Greater: 7374 case OO_LessEqual: 7375 case OO_GreaterEqual: 7376 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 7377 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true); 7378 break; 7379 7380 case OO_Percent: 7381 case OO_Caret: 7382 case OO_Pipe: 7383 case OO_LessLess: 7384 case OO_GreaterGreater: 7385 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 7386 break; 7387 7388 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 7389 if (NumArgs == 1) 7390 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7391 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 7392 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 7393 break; 7394 7395 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 7396 break; 7397 7398 case OO_Tilde: 7399 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 7400 break; 7401 7402 case OO_Equal: 7403 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 7404 // Fall through. 7405 7406 case OO_PlusEqual: 7407 case OO_MinusEqual: 7408 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 7409 // Fall through. 7410 7411 case OO_StarEqual: 7412 case OO_SlashEqual: 7413 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 7414 break; 7415 7416 case OO_PercentEqual: 7417 case OO_LessLessEqual: 7418 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 7419 case OO_AmpEqual: 7420 case OO_CaretEqual: 7421 case OO_PipeEqual: 7422 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 7423 break; 7424 7425 case OO_Exclaim: 7426 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 7427 break; 7428 7429 case OO_AmpAmp: 7430 case OO_PipePipe: 7431 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 7432 break; 7433 7434 case OO_Subscript: 7435 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 7436 break; 7437 7438 case OO_ArrowStar: 7439 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 7440 break; 7441 7442 case OO_Conditional: 7443 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 7444 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 7445 break; 7446 } 7447} 7448 7449/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 7450/// to the set of overloading candidates. 7451/// 7452/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 7453/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 7454/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 7455/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 7456void 7457Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 7458 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc, 7459 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7460 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7461 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7462 bool PartialOverloading, 7463 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) { 7464 ADLResult Fns; 7465 7466 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 7467 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 7468 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 7469 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 7470 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 7471 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 7472 7473 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 7474 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns, 7475 StdNamespaceIsAssociated); 7476 7477 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 7478 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 7479 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 7480 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 7481 if (Cand->Function) { 7482 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 7483 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 7484 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 7485 } 7486 7487 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 7488 // set. 7489 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 7490 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 7491 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 7492 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 7493 continue; 7494 7495 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 7496 PartialOverloading); 7497 } else 7498 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I), 7499 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7500 Args, CandidateSet); 7501 } 7502} 7503 7504/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 7505/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 7506bool 7507isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 7508 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 7509 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 7510 SourceLocation Loc, 7511 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 7512 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 7513 // functions. 7514 if (!Cand2.Viable) 7515 return Cand1.Viable; 7516 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 7517 return false; 7518 7519 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 7520 // 7521 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 7522 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 7523 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 7524 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 7525 unsigned StartArg = 0; 7526 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 7527 StartArg = 1; 7528 7529 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 7530 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 7531 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 7532 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 7533 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions; 7534 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 7535 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 7536 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 7537 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 7538 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 7539 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 7540 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 7541 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 7542 HasBetterConversion = true; 7543 break; 7544 7545 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 7546 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 7547 return false; 7548 7549 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 7550 // Do nothing. 7551 break; 7552 } 7553 } 7554 7555 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 7556 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 7557 if (HasBetterConversion) 7558 return true; 7559 7560 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 7561 // specialization, or, if not that, 7562 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) && 7563 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 7564 return true; 7565 7566 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 7567 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 7568 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 7569 // if not that, 7570 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() && 7571 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 7572 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 7573 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 7574 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 7575 Loc, 7576 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 7577 : TPOC_Call, 7578 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments)) 7579 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 7580 } 7581 7582 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 7583 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 7584 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 7585 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 7586 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 7587 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 7588 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 7589 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 7590 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 7591 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 7592 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 7593 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 7594 // pointer or block. 7595 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult 7596 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 7597 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 7598 return FuncResult; 7599 7600 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 7601 Cand1.FinalConversion, 7602 Cand2.FinalConversion)) { 7603 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 7604 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 7605 return true; 7606 7607 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 7608 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 7609 return false; 7610 7611 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 7612 // Do nothing 7613 break; 7614 } 7615 } 7616 7617 return false; 7618} 7619 7620/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 7621/// within an overload candidate set. 7622/// 7623/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions. 7624/// 7625/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 7626/// which overload resolution occurs. 7627/// 7628/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 7629/// function, Best points to the candidate function found. 7630/// 7631/// \returns The result of overload resolution. 7632OverloadingResult 7633OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7634 iterator &Best, 7635 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 7636 // Find the best viable function. 7637 Best = end(); 7638 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 7639 if (Cand->Viable) 7640 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, 7641 UserDefinedConversion)) 7642 Best = Cand; 7643 } 7644 7645 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 7646 if (Best == end()) 7647 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 7648 7649 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 7650 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 7651 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 7652 if (Cand->Viable && 7653 Cand != Best && 7654 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, 7655 UserDefinedConversion)) { 7656 Best = end(); 7657 return OR_Ambiguous; 7658 } 7659 } 7660 7661 // Best is the best viable function. 7662 if (Best->Function && 7663 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || 7664 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function))) 7665 return OR_Deleted; 7666 7667 return OR_Success; 7668} 7669 7670namespace { 7671 7672enum OverloadCandidateKind { 7673 oc_function, 7674 oc_method, 7675 oc_constructor, 7676 oc_function_template, 7677 oc_method_template, 7678 oc_constructor_template, 7679 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 7680 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 7681 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 7682 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 7683 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 7684 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor 7685}; 7686 7687OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 7688 FunctionDecl *Fn, 7689 std::string &Description) { 7690 bool isTemplate = false; 7691 7692 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 7693 isTemplate = true; 7694 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 7695 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 7696 } 7697 7698 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 7699 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) 7700 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor; 7701 7702 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor()) 7703 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor; 7704 7705 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 7706 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 7707 7708 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 7709 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 7710 7711 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 7712 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 7713 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 7714 } 7715 7716 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 7717 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 7718 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 7719 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 7720 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method; 7721 7722 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 7723 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 7724 7725 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 7726 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 7727 7728 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 7729 return oc_method; 7730 } 7731 7732 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function; 7733} 7734 7735void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) { 7736 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn); 7737 if (!Ctor) return; 7738 7739 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor(); 7740 if (!Ctor) return; 7741 7742 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor); 7743} 7744 7745} // end anonymous namespace 7746 7747// Notes the location of an overload candidate. 7748void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) { 7749 std::string FnDesc; 7750 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc); 7751 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 7752 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc; 7753 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 7754 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 7755 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn); 7756} 7757 7758//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 7759// OverloadedExpr 7760void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) { 7761 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 7762 7763 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 7764 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 7765 7766 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 7767 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 7768 I != IEnd; ++I) { 7769 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 7770 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 7771 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType); 7772 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 7773 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 7774 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType); 7775 } 7776 } 7777} 7778 7779/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 7780/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 7781/// target types of the conversion. 7782void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 7783 Sema &S, 7784 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 7785 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 7786 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 7787 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 7788 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator 7789 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 7790 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I); 7791 } 7792} 7793 7794namespace { 7795 7796void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) { 7797 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 7798 assert(Conv.isBad()); 7799 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 7800 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 7801 7802 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 7803 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 7804 // conversion-slot index. 7805 bool isObjectArgument = false; 7806 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 7807 if (I == 0) 7808 isObjectArgument = true; 7809 else 7810 I--; 7811 } 7812 7813 std::string FnDesc; 7814 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 7815 7816 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 7817 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 7818 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 7819 7820 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 7821 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 7822 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 7823 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 7824 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 7825 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 7826 7827 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 7828 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7829 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7830 << ToTy << Name << I+1; 7831 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7832 return; 7833 } 7834 7835 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 7836 // to a qualifier mismatch. 7837 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 7838 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 7839 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7840 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 7841 else { 7842 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 7843 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7844 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7845 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 7846 } 7847 7848 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 7849 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 7850 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 7851 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 7852 7853 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 7854 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 7855 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7856 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7857 << FromTy 7858 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 7859 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 7860 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7861 return; 7862 } 7863 7864 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 7865 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 7866 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7867 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7868 << FromTy 7869 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 7870 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 7871 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7872 return; 7873 } 7874 7875 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 7876 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 7877 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7878 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7879 << FromTy 7880 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 7881 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 7882 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7883 return; 7884 } 7885 7886 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 7887 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 7888 7889 if (isObjectArgument) { 7890 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 7891 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7892 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7893 << FromTy << (CVR - 1); 7894 } else { 7895 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 7896 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7897 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7898 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1; 7899 } 7900 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7901 return; 7902 } 7903 7904 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 7905 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 7906 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 7907 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 7908 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7909 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7910 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 7911 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7912 return; 7913 } 7914 7915 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 7916 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 7917 // the failure. 7918 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 7919 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7920 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7921 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 7922 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 7923 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7924 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7925 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 7926 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7927 return; 7928 } 7929 7930 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 7931 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 7932 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 7933 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 7934 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 7935 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 7936 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 7937 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 7938 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 7939 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 7940 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 7941 } 7942 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 7943 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 7944 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 7945 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 7946 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 7947 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 7948 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 7949 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 7950 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 7951 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 7952 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 7953 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 7954 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 7955 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 7956 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) 7957 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 7958 } 7959 7960 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 7961 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 7962 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 7963 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7964 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7965 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) 7966 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1; 7967 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7968 return; 7969 } 7970 7971 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 7972 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 7973 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 7974 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 7975 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 7976 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 7977 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7978 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7979 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 7980 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7981 return; 7982 } 7983 } 7984 7985 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 7986 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 7987 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 7988 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7989 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1 7990 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind); 7991 7992 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 7993 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 7994 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 7995 FDiag << *HI; 7996 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 7997 7998 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 7999} 8000 8001void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 8002 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 8003 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 8004 8005 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 8006 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 8007 8008 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 8009 8010 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 8011 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the 8012 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 8013 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 8014 // Just don't report anything. 8015 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 8016 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 8017 return; 8018 8019 // at least / at most / exactly 8020 unsigned mode, modeCount; 8021 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 8022 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 8023 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 8024 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 8025 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() || 8026 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 8027 mode = 0; // "at least" 8028 else 8029 mode = 2; // "exactly" 8030 modeCount = MinParams; 8031 } else { 8032 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 8033 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 8034 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 8035 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs()) 8036 mode = 1; // "at most" 8037 else 8038 mode = 2; // "exactly" 8039 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs(); 8040 } 8041 8042 std::string Description; 8043 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description); 8044 8045 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 8046 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode 8047 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 8048 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8049} 8050 8051/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 8052void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 8053 unsigned NumArgs) { 8054 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern 8055 8056 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 8057 NamedDecl *ParamD; 8058 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 8059 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 8060 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 8061 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) { 8062 case Sema::TDK_Success: 8063 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 8064 8065 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 8066 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 8067 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 8068 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 8069 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8070 return; 8071 } 8072 8073 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 8074 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 8075 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 8076 8077 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 8078 8079 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 8080 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 8081 QualifierCollector Qs; 8082 Qs.strip(Param); 8083 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 8084 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 8085 8086 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 8087 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 8088 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 8089 // done on dependent types). 8090 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 8091 8092 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 8093 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 8094 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8095 return; 8096 } 8097 8098 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 8099 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 8100 int which = 0; 8101 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 8102 which = 0; 8103 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 8104 which = 1; 8105 else { 8106 which = 2; 8107 } 8108 8109 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 8110 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() 8111 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 8112 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 8113 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8114 return; 8115 } 8116 8117 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 8118 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 8119 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 8120 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 8121 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 8122 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 8123 else { 8124 int index = 0; 8125 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 8126 index = TTP->getIndex(); 8127 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 8128 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 8129 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 8130 else 8131 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 8132 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 8133 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 8134 << (index + 1); 8135 } 8136 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8137 return; 8138 8139 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 8140 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 8141 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 8142 return; 8143 8144 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 8145 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 8146 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8147 return; 8148 8149 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 8150 std::string ArgString; 8151 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args 8152 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) 8153 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 8154 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), 8155 *Args); 8156 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 8157 << ArgString; 8158 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8159 return; 8160 } 8161 8162 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 8163 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 8164 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 8165 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 8166 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 8167 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8168 return; 8169 } 8170} 8171 8172/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 8173void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 8174 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 8175 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 8176 8177 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 8178 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 8179 8180 std::string FnDesc; 8181 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc); 8182 8183 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 8184 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 8185} 8186 8187/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 8188/// already generated a primary error at the call site. 8189/// 8190/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 8191/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 8192/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 8193/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 8194/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 8195/// overload. 8196/// 8197/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 8198/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 8199/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 8200void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 8201 unsigned NumArgs) { 8202 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 8203 8204 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 8205 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || 8206 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) { 8207 std::string FnDesc; 8208 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 8209 8210 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 8211 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted(); 8212 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8213 return; 8214 } 8215 8216 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 8217 if (Cand->Viable) { 8218 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 8219 return; 8220 } 8221 8222 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 8223 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 8224 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 8225 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 8226 8227 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 8228 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs); 8229 8230 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 8231 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 8232 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 8233 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 8234 8235 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 8236 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 8237 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I) 8238 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 8239 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I); 8240 8241 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 8242 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 8243 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 8244 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 8245 } 8246 8247 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 8248 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 8249 } 8250} 8251 8252void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 8253 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 8254 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 8255 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 8256 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 8257 bool isLValueReference = false; 8258 bool isRValueReference = false; 8259 bool isPointer = false; 8260 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 8261 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 8262 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8263 isLValueReference = true; 8264 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 8265 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 8266 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8267 isRValueReference = true; 8268 } 8269 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8270 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8271 isPointer = true; 8272 } 8273 // Desugar down to a function type. 8274 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 8275 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 8276 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 8277 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 8278 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 8279 8280 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 8281 << FnType; 8282 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate); 8283} 8284 8285void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, 8286 const char *Opc, 8287 SourceLocation OpLoc, 8288 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 8289 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 8290 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 8291 TypeStr += Opc; 8292 TypeStr += "("; 8293 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 8294 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) { 8295 TypeStr += ")"; 8296 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr; 8297 } else { 8298 TypeStr += ", "; 8299 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 8300 TypeStr += ")"; 8301 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr; 8302 } 8303} 8304 8305void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 8306 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 8307 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions; 8308 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) { 8309 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx]; 8310 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 8311 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 8312 8313 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc, 8314 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 8315 } 8316} 8317 8318SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 8319 if (Cand->Function) 8320 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 8321 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 8322 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 8323 return SourceLocation(); 8324} 8325 8326static unsigned 8327RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 8328 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 8329 case Sema::TDK_Success: 8330 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 8331 8332 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 8333 return 1; 8334 8335 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 8336 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 8337 return 2; 8338 8339 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 8340 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 8341 return 3; 8342 8343 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 8344 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 8345 return 4; 8346 8347 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 8348 return 5; 8349 8350 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 8351 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 8352 return 6; 8353 } 8354 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 8355} 8356 8357struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 8358 Sema &S; 8359 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 8360 8361 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 8362 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 8363 // Fast-path this check. 8364 if (L == R) return false; 8365 8366 // Order first by viability. 8367 if (L->Viable) { 8368 if (!R->Viable) return true; 8369 8370 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 8371 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 8372 // that could exploit it. 8373 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true; 8374 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false; 8375 } else if (R->Viable) 8376 return false; 8377 8378 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 8379 8380 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 8381 if (!L->Viable) { 8382 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 8383 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 8384 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 8385 return false; 8386 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 8387 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 8388 return true; 8389 8390 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 8391 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 8392 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 8393 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 8394 return true; 8395 8396 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 8397 // comes first. 8398 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 8399 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 8400 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 8401 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 8402 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 8403 if (numLFixes < numRFixes) 8404 return true; 8405 else 8406 return false; 8407 } 8408 8409 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 8410 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 8411 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions); 8412 8413 int leftBetter = 0; 8414 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 8415 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) { 8416 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 8417 L->Conversions[I], 8418 R->Conversions[I])) { 8419 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 8420 leftBetter++; 8421 break; 8422 8423 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 8424 leftBetter--; 8425 break; 8426 8427 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 8428 break; 8429 } 8430 } 8431 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 8432 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 8433 8434 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 8435 return false; 8436 8437 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 8438 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 8439 return true; 8440 8441 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 8442 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 8443 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 8444 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 8445 return false; 8446 8447 // TODO: others? 8448 } 8449 8450 // Sort everything else by location. 8451 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 8452 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 8453 8454 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 8455 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 8456 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 8457 8458 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 8459 } 8460}; 8461 8462/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 8463/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible. 8464void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 8465 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 8466 assert(!Cand->Viable); 8467 8468 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 8469 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return; 8470 8471 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 8472 bool Unfixable = false; 8473 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 8474 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 8475 8476 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion. 8477 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 8478 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions; 8479 while (true) { 8480 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 8481 ConvIdx++; 8482 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) { 8483 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S); 8484 break; 8485 } 8486 } 8487 8488 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount) 8489 return; 8490 8491 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 8492 "remaining conversion is initialized?"); 8493 8494 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 8495 // operation somehow. 8496 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 8497 8498 const FunctionProtoType* Proto; 8499 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx; 8500 8501 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 8502 QualType ConvType 8503 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 8504 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 8505 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 8506 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 8507 ArgIdx--; 8508 } else if (Cand->Function) { 8509 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 8510 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 8511 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) 8512 ArgIdx--; 8513 } else { 8514 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion. 8515 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 8516 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx) 8517 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 8518 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx], 8519 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx], 8520 SuppressUserConversions, 8521 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true, 8522 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 8523 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8524 return; 8525 } 8526 8527 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 8528 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 8529 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) { 8530 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 8531 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 8532 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx), 8533 SuppressUserConversions, 8534 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 8535 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 8536 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8537 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 8538 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 8539 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 8540 } 8541 else 8542 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 8543 } 8544} 8545 8546} // end anonymous namespace 8547 8548/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints 8549/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate 8550/// set. 8551void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, 8552 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, 8553 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8554 const char *Opc, 8555 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 8556 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 8557 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 8558 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 8559 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 8560 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 8561 if (Cand->Viable) 8562 Cands.push_back(Cand); 8563 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) { 8564 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args); 8565 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate) 8566 Cands.push_back(Cand); 8567 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 8568 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 8569 } 8570 } 8571 8572 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 8573 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 8574 8575 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 8576 8577 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E; 8578 const DiagnosticsEngine::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = 8579 S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 8580 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 8581 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 8582 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 8583 8584 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 8585 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 8586 // candidate list. 8587 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == DiagnosticsEngine::Ovl_Best) { 8588 break; 8589 } 8590 ++CandsShown; 8591 8592 if (Cand->Function) 8593 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size()); 8594 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 8595 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 8596 else { 8597 assert(Cand->Viable && 8598 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 8599 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 8600 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 8601 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 8602 // 8603 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 8604 // different ambiguities, though. 8605 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 8606 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 8607 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 8608 } 8609 8610 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 8611 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 8612 } 8613 } 8614 8615 if (I != E) 8616 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 8617} 8618 8619// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 8620// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 8621// R (A) --> R(A) 8622// R (*)(A) --> R (A) 8623// R (&)(A) --> R (A) 8624// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 8625QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 8626 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 8627 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 8628 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 8629 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8630 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 8631 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8632 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8633 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 8634 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8635 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8636 Ret = 8637 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 8638 return Ret; 8639} 8640 8641// A helper class to help with address of function resolution 8642// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 8643class AddressOfFunctionResolver 8644{ 8645 Sema& S; 8646 Expr* SourceExpr; 8647 const QualType& TargetType; 8648 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 8649 8650 bool Complain; 8651 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 8652 ASTContext& Context; 8653 8654 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 8655 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 8656 8657 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 8658 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 8659 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 8660 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 8661 8662public: 8663 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr, 8664 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain) 8665 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 8666 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 8667 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 8668 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 8669 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 8670 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 8671 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression) 8672 { 8673 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 8674 8675 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 8676 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 8677 DeclAccessPair dap; 8678 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 8679 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) { 8680 8681 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 8682 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 8683 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function 8684 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was 8685 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 8686 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 8687 8688 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 8689 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 8690 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 8691 return; 8692 } 8693 } 8694 8695 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn)); 8696 } 8697 } 8698 return; 8699 } 8700 8701 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 8702 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 8703 8704 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 8705 // C++ [over.over]p4: 8706 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 8707 if (Matches.size() > 1) { 8708 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 8709 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 8710 else 8711 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 8712 } 8713 } 8714 } 8715 8716private: 8717 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 8718 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 8719 } 8720 8721 // [ToType] [Return] 8722 8723 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 8724 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 8725 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 8726 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 8727 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 8728 } 8729 8730 // return true if any matching specializations were found 8731 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 8732 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 8733 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 8734 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 8735 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 8736 // static when converting to member pointer. 8737 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 8738 return false; 8739 } 8740 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 8741 return false; 8742 8743 // C++ [over.over]p2: 8744 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 8745 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 8746 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 8747 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 8748 // overloaded functions considered. 8749 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 8750 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc()); 8751 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 8752 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 8753 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 8754 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 8755 Info)) { 8756 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 8757 (void)Result; 8758 return false; 8759 } 8760 8761 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match. 8762 // This function template specicalization works. 8763 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl()); 8764 assert(TargetFunctionType 8765 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType())); 8766 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 8767 return true; 8768 } 8769 8770 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 8771 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 8772 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 8773 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 8774 // when converting to member pointer. 8775 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 8776 return false; 8777 } 8778 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 8779 return false; 8780 8781 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 8782 if (S.getLangOptions().CUDA) 8783 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 8784 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl)) 8785 return false; 8786 8787 QualType ResultTy; 8788 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, 8789 FunDecl->getType()) || 8790 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType, 8791 ResultTy)) { 8792 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, 8793 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 8794 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 8795 return true; 8796 } 8797 } 8798 8799 return false; 8800 } 8801 8802 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 8803 bool Ret = false; 8804 8805 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 8806 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 8807 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 8808 return false; 8809 8810 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 8811 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 8812 I != E; ++I) { 8813 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 8814 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 8815 8816 // C++ [over.over]p3: 8817 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 8818 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 8819 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 8820 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 8821 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 8822 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 8823 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 8824 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 8825 Ret = true; 8826 } 8827 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 8828 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 8829 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 8830 Ret = true; 8831 } 8832 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 8833 return Ret; 8834 } 8835 8836 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 8837 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 8838 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 8839 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 8840 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 8841 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 8842 8843 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 8844 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 8845 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 8846 // best function template (if it exists). 8847 8848 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 8849 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 8850 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 8851 8852 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = 8853 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), 8854 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), 8855 S.PDiag(), 8856 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 8857 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 8858 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 8859 << (unsigned) oc_function_template, 8860 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 8861 8862 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 8863 // Make it the first and only element 8864 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 8865 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 8866 Matches.resize(1); 8867 } 8868 } 8869 8870 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 8871 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 8872 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 8873 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 8874 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0) 8875 ++I; 8876 else { 8877 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 8878 Matches.set_size(N); 8879 } 8880 } 8881 } 8882 8883public: 8884 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 8885 assert(Matches.empty()); 8886 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 8887 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 8888 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 8889 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType); 8890 } 8891 8892 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 8893 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 8894 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 8895 } 8896 8897 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 8898 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 8899 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 8900 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 8901 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 8902 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 8903 } 8904 8905 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 8906 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 8907 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 8908 } 8909 8910 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 8911 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 8912 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 8913 << OvlExpr->getName() 8914 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 8915 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType); 8916 } 8917 8918 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 8919 8920 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 8921 8922 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 8923 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0; 8924 return Matches[0].second; 8925 } 8926 8927 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 8928 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0; 8929 return &Matches[0].first; 8930 } 8931}; 8932 8933/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 8934/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 8935/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 8936/// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 8937/// 8938/// @code 8939/// int f(double); 8940/// int f(int); 8941/// 8942/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 8943/// @endcode 8944/// 8945/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 8946/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 8947/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 8948FunctionDecl * 8949Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 8950 QualType TargetType, 8951 bool Complain, 8952 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 8953 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 8954 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 8955 8956 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 8957 Complain); 8958 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 8959 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0; 8960 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) { 8961 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 8962 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 8963 else 8964 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 8965 } 8966 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain) 8967 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 8968 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 8969 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 8970 assert(Fn); 8971 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 8972 MarkFunctionReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn); 8973 if (Complain) 8974 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 8975 } 8976 8977 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 8978 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 8979 return Fn; 8980} 8981 8982/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 8983/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 8984/// 8985/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 8986/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 8987/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 8988/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 8989FunctionDecl * 8990Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 8991 bool Complain, 8992 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 8993 // C++ [over.over]p1: 8994 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 8995 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 8996 // C++ [over.over]p1: 8997 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 8998 // operator. 8999 9000 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 9001 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 9002 return 0; 9003 9004 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 9005 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 9006 9007 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 9008 // whose type matches exactly. 9009 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0; 9010 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 9011 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 9012 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 9013 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 9014 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 9015 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 9016 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 9017 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 9018 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 9019 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 9020 9021 // C++ [over.over]p2: 9022 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 9023 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 9024 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 9025 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 9026 // overloaded functions considered. 9027 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 9028 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc()); 9029 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 9030 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9031 Specialization, Info)) { 9032 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 9033 (void)Result; 9034 continue; 9035 } 9036 9037 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 9038 9039 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 9040 if (Matched) { 9041 if (Complain) { 9042 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 9043 << ovl->getName(); 9044 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 9045 } 9046 return 0; 9047 } 9048 9049 Matched = Specialization; 9050 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 9051 } 9052 9053 return Matched; 9054} 9055 9056 9057 9058 9059// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 9060// because it identifies a single function template specialization. 9061// 9062// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 9063// 9064// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 9065// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 9066// returns true if 'complain' is set. 9067bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9068 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 9069 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining, 9070 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 9071 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 9072 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 9073 9074 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 9075 9076 DeclAccessPair found; 9077 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 9078 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9079 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 9080 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) { 9081 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 9082 return true; 9083 } 9084 9085 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 9086 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 9087 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 9088 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 9089 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 9090 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 9091 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 9092 if (!complain) return false; 9093 9094 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 9095 diag::err_bound_member_function) 9096 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 9097 9098 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 9099 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 9100 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 9101 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 9102 // the static candidates were rejected. 9103 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 9104 return true; 9105 } 9106 9107 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'. 9108 SingleFunctionExpression = 9109 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn)); 9110 9111 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 9112 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 9113 SingleFunctionExpression = 9114 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take()); 9115 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 9116 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 9117 return true; 9118 } 9119 } 9120 } 9121 9122 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 9123 if (complain) { 9124 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 9125 << ovl.Expression->getName() 9126 << DestTypeForComplaining 9127 << OpRangeForComplaining 9128 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 9129 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 9130 9131 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 9132 return true; 9133 } 9134 9135 return false; 9136 } 9137 9138 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 9139 return true; 9140} 9141 9142/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set. 9143static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 9144 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 9145 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9146 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9147 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 9148 bool PartialOverloading, 9149 bool KnownValid) { 9150 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 9151 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 9152 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 9153 9154 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 9155 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 9156 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 9157 return; 9158 } 9159 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 9160 PartialOverloading); 9161 return; 9162 } 9163 9164 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 9165 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 9166 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 9167 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet); 9168 return; 9169 } 9170 9171 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 9172} 9173 9174/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 9175/// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 9176void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 9177 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9178 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 9179 bool PartialOverloading) { 9180 9181#ifndef NDEBUG 9182 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 9183 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 9184 // 9185 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 9186 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 9187 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 9188 // 9189 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 9190 // 9191 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 9192 // using-declaration, or 9193 // 9194 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 9195 // template 9196 // 9197 // then Y is empty. 9198 9199 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 9200 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 9201 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 9202 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 9203 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 9204 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 9205 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 9206 } 9207 } 9208#endif 9209 9210 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 9211 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 9212 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 9213 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 9214 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 9215 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 9216 } 9217 9218 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 9219 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 9220 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 9221 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 9222 /*KnownValid*/ true); 9223 9224 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 9225 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false, 9226 ULE->getExprLoc(), 9227 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9228 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 9229 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace()); 9230} 9231 9232/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 9233/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 9234/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 9235/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 9236/// 9237/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 9238static bool 9239DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 9240 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 9241 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9242 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 9243 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty()) 9244 return false; 9245 9246 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 9247 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 9248 9249 if (!R.empty()) { 9250 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 9251 9252 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 9253 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 9254 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 9255 R.clear(); 9256 return false; 9257 } 9258 9259 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc); 9260 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 9261 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 9262 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 9263 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 9264 9265 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 9266 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 9267 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 9268 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 9269 R.clear(); 9270 return false; 9271 } 9272 9273 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 9274 // declaring the function there instead. 9275 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 9276 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 9277 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, 9278 AssociatedNamespaces, 9279 AssociatedClasses); 9280 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 9281 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 9282 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) { 9283 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 9284 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 9285 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 9286 if (!Std->Encloses(*it)) 9287 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 9288 } 9289 } else { 9290 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces. 9291 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces; 9292 } 9293 9294 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 9295 << R.getLookupName(); 9296 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 9297 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 9298 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 9299 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 9300 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 9301 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 9302 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 9303 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 9304 } else { 9305 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 9306 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 9307 // a localized representation of a list of items. 9308 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 9309 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 9310 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 9311 } 9312 9313 // Try to recover by calling this function. 9314 return true; 9315 } 9316 9317 R.clear(); 9318 } 9319 9320 return false; 9321} 9322 9323/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 9324/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 9325/// was defined. 9326/// 9327/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 9328static bool 9329DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 9330 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9331 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 9332 DeclarationName OpName = 9333 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 9334 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 9335 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 9336 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args); 9337} 9338 9339namespace { 9340// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections 9341// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions) 9342// that accept the given number of arguments. 9343class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 9344 public: 9345 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs) 9346 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) { 9347 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus; 9348 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 9349 } 9350 9351 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) { 9352 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) 9353 return candidate.isKeyword(); 9354 9355 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(), 9356 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) { 9357 FunctionDecl *FD = 0; 9358 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 9359 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) 9360 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 9361 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) { 9362 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) { 9363 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function, 9364 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so, 9365 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee. 9366 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType(); 9367 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType()) 9368 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType(); 9369 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 9370 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs) 9371 return true; 9372 } 9373 } 9374 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs && 9375 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs) 9376 return true; 9377 } 9378 return false; 9379 } 9380 9381 private: 9382 unsigned NumArgs; 9383 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs; 9384}; 9385 9386// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction 9387class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 9388 public: 9389 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() { 9390 WantTypeSpecifiers = false; 9391 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 9392 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 9393 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 9394 } 9395 9396 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) { 9397 return false; 9398 } 9399}; 9400} 9401 9402/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 9403/// 9404/// Returns true if new candidates were found. 9405static ExprResult 9406BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 9407 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 9408 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 9409 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9410 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 9411 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 9412 9413 CXXScopeSpec SS; 9414 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 9415 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 9416 9417 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 9418 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 9419 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 9420 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 9421 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 9422 } 9423 9424 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 9425 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 9426 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0); 9427 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll; 9428 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ? 9429 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator : 9430 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll; 9431 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 9432 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) && 9433 (!EmptyLookup || 9434 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC, 9435 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args))) 9436 return ExprError(); 9437 9438 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 9439 9440 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 9441 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 9442 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 9443 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 9444 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 9445 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs); 9446 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 9447 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 9448 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 9449 else 9450 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 9451 9452 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 9453 return ExprError(); 9454 9455 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 9456 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 9457 // end up here. 9458 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc, 9459 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 9460 RParenLoc); 9461} 9462 9463/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn 9464/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 9465/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 9466/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 9467/// the function declaration produced by overload 9468/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the 9469/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL. 9470ExprResult 9471Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 9472 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 9473 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 9474 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 9475 Expr *ExecConfig, 9476 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 9477#ifndef NDEBUG 9478 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 9479 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 9480 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 9481 9482 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 9483 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 9484 FunctionDecl *F; 9485 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 9486 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 9487 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 9488 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 9489 9490 // We don't perform ADL in C. 9491 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 9492 } else 9493 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() && 9494 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL"); 9495#endif 9496 9497 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 9498 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) 9499 return ExprError(); 9500 9501 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc()); 9502 9503 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 9504 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 9505 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 9506 CandidateSet); 9507 9508 // If we found nothing, try to recover. 9509 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail 9510 // out if it fails. 9511 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 9512 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then 9513 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup 9514 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base 9515 // classes. 9516 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() && 9517 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 9518 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs, 9519 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 9520 RParenLoc); 9521 CE->setTypeDependent(true); 9522 return Owned(CE); 9523 } 9524 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 9525 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs), 9526 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 9527 AllowTypoCorrection); 9528 } 9529 9530 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 9531 9532 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 9533 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) { 9534 case OR_Success: { 9535 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function; 9536 MarkFunctionReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl); 9537 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl); 9538 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()); 9539 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl); 9540 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc, 9541 ExecConfig); 9542 } 9543 9544 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 9545 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 9546 // have meant to call. 9547 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 9548 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs), 9549 RParenLoc, 9550 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 9551 AllowTypoCorrection); 9552 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 9553 return Recovery; 9554 9555 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 9556 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 9557 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 9558 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 9559 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 9560 break; 9561 } 9562 9563 case OR_Ambiguous: 9564 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 9565 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 9566 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 9567 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 9568 break; 9569 9570 case OR_Deleted: 9571 { 9572 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 9573 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 9574 << ULE->getName() 9575 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 9576 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 9577 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 9578 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 9579 9580 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep 9581 // the call in the AST. 9582 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function; 9583 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl); 9584 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, 9585 RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 9586 } 9587 } 9588 9589 // Overload resolution failed. 9590 return ExprError(); 9591} 9592 9593static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 9594 return Functions.size() > 1 || 9595 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 9596} 9597 9598/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 9599/// operator. 9600/// 9601/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 9602/// 9603/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 9604/// operator. 9605/// 9606/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be 9607/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 9608/// set based on the context using, e.g., 9609/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 9610/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 9611/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 9612/// 9613/// \param input The input argument. 9614ExprResult 9615Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn, 9616 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 9617 Expr *Input) { 9618 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 9619 9620 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 9621 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 9622 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 9623 // TODO: provide better source location info. 9624 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 9625 9626 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 9627 return ExprError(); 9628 9629 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 }; 9630 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 9631 9632 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 9633 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 9634 // post-decrement. 9635 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 9636 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 9637 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 9638 SourceLocation()); 9639 NumArgs = 2; 9640 } 9641 9642 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 9643 if (Fns.empty()) 9644 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, 9645 Opc, 9646 Context.DependentTy, 9647 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 9648 OpLoc)); 9649 9650 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 9651 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 9652 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 9653 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 9654 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 9655 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 9656 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, 9657 &Args[0], NumArgs, 9658 Context.DependentTy, 9659 VK_RValue, 9660 OpLoc)); 9661 } 9662 9663 // Build an empty overload set. 9664 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc); 9665 9666 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 9667 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet, 9668 false); 9669 9670 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 9671 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet); 9672 9673 // Add candidates from ADL. 9674 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, 9675 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 9676 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0, 9677 CandidateSet); 9678 9679 // Add builtin operator candidates. 9680 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet); 9681 9682 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 9683 9684 // Perform overload resolution. 9685 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 9686 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 9687 case OR_Success: { 9688 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 9689 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 9690 9691 if (FnDecl) { 9692 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 9693 // operator. 9694 9695 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl); 9696 9697 // Convert the arguments. 9698 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 9699 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl); 9700 9701 ExprResult InputRes = 9702 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0, 9703 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 9704 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 9705 return ExprError(); 9706 Input = InputRes.take(); 9707 } else { 9708 // Convert the arguments. 9709 ExprResult InputInit 9710 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 9711 Context, 9712 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 9713 SourceLocation(), 9714 Input); 9715 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 9716 return ExprError(); 9717 Input = InputInit.take(); 9718 } 9719 9720 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 9721 9722 // Determine the result type. 9723 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 9724 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 9725 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 9726 9727 // Build the actual expression node. 9728 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 9729 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 9730 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 9731 return ExprError(); 9732 9733 Args[0] = Input; 9734 CallExpr *TheCall = 9735 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(), 9736 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 9737 9738 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 9739 FnDecl)) 9740 return ExprError(); 9741 9742 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 9743 } else { 9744 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 9745 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 9746 // operator node. 9747 ExprResult InputRes = 9748 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 9749 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 9750 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 9751 return ExprError(); 9752 Input = InputRes.take(); 9753 break; 9754 } 9755 } 9756 9757 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 9758 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 9759 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 9760 // defined too late to be candidates. 9761 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, 9762 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs))) 9763 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 9764 return ExprError(); 9765 9766 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 9767 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 9768 break; 9769 9770 case OR_Ambiguous: 9771 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 9772 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 9773 << Input->getType() 9774 << Input->getSourceRange(); 9775 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 9776 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 9777 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 9778 return ExprError(); 9779 9780 case OR_Deleted: 9781 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 9782 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 9783 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 9784 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 9785 << Input->getSourceRange(); 9786 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 9787 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 9788 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 9789 return ExprError(); 9790 } 9791 9792 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 9793 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 9794 // build a built-in operation. 9795 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 9796} 9797 9798/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 9799/// operator. 9800/// 9801/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 9802/// 9803/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 9804/// operator. 9805/// 9806/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be 9807/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 9808/// set based on the context using, e.g., 9809/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 9810/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 9811/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 9812/// 9813/// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 9814/// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 9815ExprResult 9816Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 9817 unsigned OpcIn, 9818 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 9819 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 9820 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 9821 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 9822 9823 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 9824 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 9825 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 9826 9827 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 9828 // expression. 9829 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 9830 if (Fns.empty()) { 9831 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 9832 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 9833 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 9834 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 9835 Context.DependentTy, 9836 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 9837 OpLoc)); 9838 9839 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 9840 Context.DependentTy, 9841 VK_LValue, 9842 OK_Ordinary, 9843 Context.DependentTy, 9844 Context.DependentTy, 9845 OpLoc)); 9846 } 9847 9848 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 9849 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 9850 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 9851 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 9852 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 9853 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 9854 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 9855 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 9856 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 9857 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, 9858 Args, 2, 9859 Context.DependentTy, 9860 VK_RValue, 9861 OpLoc)); 9862 } 9863 9864 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 9865 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 9866 return ExprError(); 9867 9868 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 9869 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 9870 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 9871 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 9872 return ExprError(); 9873 9874 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 9875 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 9876 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 9877 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 9878 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 9879 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 9880 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 9881 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 9882 9883 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 9884 // create a built-in binary operator. 9885 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 9886 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 9887 9888 // Build an empty overload set. 9889 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc); 9890 9891 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 9892 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false); 9893 9894 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 9895 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 9896 9897 // Add candidates from ADL. 9898 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, 9899 OpLoc, Args, 9900 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0, 9901 CandidateSet); 9902 9903 // Add builtin operator candidates. 9904 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 9905 9906 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 9907 9908 // Perform overload resolution. 9909 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 9910 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 9911 case OR_Success: { 9912 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 9913 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 9914 9915 if (FnDecl) { 9916 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 9917 // operator. 9918 9919 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl); 9920 9921 // Convert the arguments. 9922 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 9923 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 9924 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 9925 9926 ExprResult Arg1 = 9927 PerformCopyInitialization( 9928 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 9929 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 9930 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1])); 9931 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 9932 return ExprError(); 9933 9934 ExprResult Arg0 = 9935 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0, 9936 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 9937 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 9938 return ExprError(); 9939 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>(); 9940 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>(); 9941 } else { 9942 // Convert the arguments. 9943 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 9944 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 9945 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 9946 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0])); 9947 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 9948 return ExprError(); 9949 9950 ExprResult Arg1 = 9951 PerformCopyInitialization( 9952 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 9953 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 9954 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1])); 9955 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 9956 return ExprError(); 9957 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>(); 9958 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>(); 9959 } 9960 9961 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 9962 9963 // Determine the result type. 9964 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 9965 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 9966 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 9967 9968 // Build the actual expression node. 9969 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 9970 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 9971 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 9972 return ExprError(); 9973 9974 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 9975 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(), 9976 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 9977 9978 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 9979 FnDecl)) 9980 return ExprError(); 9981 9982 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 9983 } else { 9984 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 9985 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 9986 // operator node. 9987 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 9988 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 9989 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 9990 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 9991 return ExprError(); 9992 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take(); 9993 9994 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 9995 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 9996 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 9997 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 9998 return ExprError(); 9999 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take(); 10000 break; 10001 } 10002 } 10003 10004 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 10005 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 10006 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 10007 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 10008 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 10009 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 10010 break; 10011 10012 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment 10013 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 10014 // no overloaded assignment operator found 10015 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 10016 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 10017 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 10018 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 10019 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10020 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10021 } else { 10022 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 10023 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 10024 // defined too late to be candidates. 10025 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 10026 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 10027 return ExprError(); 10028 10029 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 10030 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 10031 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 10032 } 10033 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 10034 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 10035 if (Result.isInvalid()) 10036 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10037 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 10038 return move(Result); 10039 } 10040 10041 case OR_Ambiguous: 10042 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 10043 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10044 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 10045 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10046 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 10047 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 10048 return ExprError(); 10049 10050 case OR_Deleted: 10051 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 10052 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10053 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 10054 << getSpecialMember(Method) 10055 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10056 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function); 10057 10058 if (Method->getParent()->isLambda()) { 10059 Diag(Method->getParent()->getLocation(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 10060 return ExprError(); 10061 } 10062 } else { 10063 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 10064 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10065 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10066 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10067 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10068 } 10069 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10070 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 10071 return ExprError(); 10072 } 10073 10074 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 10075 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 10076} 10077 10078ExprResult 10079Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 10080 SourceLocation RLoc, 10081 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 10082 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 10083 DeclarationName OpName = 10084 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 10085 10086 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 10087 // expression. 10088 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 10089 10090 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 10091 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 10092 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 10093 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 10094 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 10095 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 10096 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 10097 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 10098 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 10099 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 10100 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 10101 10102 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, 10103 Args, 2, 10104 Context.DependentTy, 10105 VK_RValue, 10106 RLoc)); 10107 } 10108 10109 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 10110 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 10111 return ExprError(); 10112 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 10113 return ExprError(); 10114 10115 // Build an empty overload set. 10116 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc); 10117 10118 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 10119 10120 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 10121 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 10122 10123 // Add builtin operator candidates. 10124 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 10125 10126 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10127 10128 // Perform overload resolution. 10129 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10130 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 10131 case OR_Success: { 10132 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 10133 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 10134 10135 if (FnDecl) { 10136 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 10137 // operator. 10138 10139 MarkFunctionReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl); 10140 10141 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 10142 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc); 10143 10144 // Convert the arguments. 10145 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 10146 ExprResult Arg0 = 10147 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0, 10148 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 10149 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 10150 return ExprError(); 10151 Args[0] = Arg0.take(); 10152 10153 // Convert the arguments. 10154 ExprResult InputInit 10155 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 10156 Context, 10157 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 10158 SourceLocation(), 10159 Owned(Args[1])); 10160 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 10161 return ExprError(); 10162 10163 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>(); 10164 10165 // Determine the result type 10166 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 10167 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10168 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10169 10170 // Build the actual expression node. 10171 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 10172 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 10173 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 10174 HadMultipleCandidates, 10175 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 10176 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 10177 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 10178 return ExprError(); 10179 10180 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 10181 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, 10182 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2, 10183 ResultTy, VK, RLoc); 10184 10185 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall, 10186 FnDecl)) 10187 return ExprError(); 10188 10189 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10190 } else { 10191 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 10192 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 10193 // operator node. 10194 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 10195 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 10196 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 10197 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 10198 return ExprError(); 10199 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take(); 10200 10201 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 10202 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 10203 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 10204 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 10205 return ExprError(); 10206 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take(); 10207 10208 break; 10209 } 10210 } 10211 10212 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 10213 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 10214 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 10215 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 10216 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10217 else 10218 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 10219 << Args[0]->getType() 10220 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10221 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10222 "[]", LLoc); 10223 return ExprError(); 10224 } 10225 10226 case OR_Ambiguous: 10227 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 10228 << "[]" 10229 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 10230 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10231 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 10232 "[]", LLoc); 10233 return ExprError(); 10234 10235 case OR_Deleted: 10236 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 10237 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]" 10238 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10239 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10240 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10241 "[]", LLoc); 10242 return ExprError(); 10243 } 10244 10245 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 10246 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 10247} 10248 10249/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 10250/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 10251/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 10252/// arguments to the function call (not including the object 10253/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 10254/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 10255/// member function. 10256ExprResult 10257Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 10258 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args, 10259 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10260 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 10261 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10262 10263 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 10264 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 10265 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 10266 10267 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 10268 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 10269 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 10270 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 10271 10272 QualType fnType = 10273 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10274 10275 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10276 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 10277 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType()); 10278 10279 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 10280 // member function we're calling. 10281 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals()); 10282 10283 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 10284 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 10285 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10286 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 10287 10288 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 10289 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 10290 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 10291 if (difference) { 10292 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 10293 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 10294 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 10295 << qualsString 10296 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 10297 } 10298 10299 CXXMemberCallExpr *call 10300 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs, 10301 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc); 10302 10303 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(), 10304 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(), 10305 call, 0)) 10306 return ExprError(); 10307 10308 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc)) 10309 return ExprError(); 10310 10311 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 10312 } 10313 10314 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 10315 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) 10316 return ExprError(); 10317 10318 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 10319 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0; 10320 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public); 10321 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0; 10322 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 10323 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 10324 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 10325 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 10326 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 10327 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10328 } else { 10329 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 10330 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 10331 10332 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 10333 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 10334 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 10335 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 10336 10337 // Add overload candidates 10338 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc()); 10339 10340 // FIXME: avoid copy. 10341 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 10342 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 10343 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 10344 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 10345 } 10346 10347 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 10348 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 10349 10350 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 10351 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 10352 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 10353 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 10354 10355 10356 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 10357 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 10358 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), 10359 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet); 10360 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 10361 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 10362 // non-template member function. 10363 if (TemplateArgs) 10364 continue; 10365 10366 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 10367 ObjectClassification, 10368 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet, 10369 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 10370 } else { 10371 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), 10372 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs, 10373 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 10374 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 10375 CandidateSet, 10376 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false); 10377 } 10378 } 10379 10380 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 10381 10382 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10383 10384 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10385 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), 10386 Best)) { 10387 case OR_Success: 10388 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10389 MarkFunctionReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method); 10390 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 10391 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 10392 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()); 10393 break; 10394 10395 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10396 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 10397 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 10398 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 10399 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10400 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10401 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 10402 return ExprError(); 10403 10404 case OR_Ambiguous: 10405 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 10406 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 10407 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10408 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10409 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 10410 return ExprError(); 10411 10412 case OR_Deleted: 10413 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 10414 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10415 << DeclName 10416 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10417 << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 10418 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10419 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10420 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 10421 return ExprError(); 10422 } 10423 10424 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 10425 10426 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 10427 // non-member call based on that function. 10428 if (Method->isStatic()) { 10429 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, 10430 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc); 10431 } 10432 10433 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 10434 } 10435 10436 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType(); 10437 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 10438 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10439 10440 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 10441 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 10442 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs, 10443 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc); 10444 10445 // Check for a valid return type. 10446 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 10447 TheCall, Method)) 10448 return ExprError(); 10449 10450 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 10451 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 10452 // it was done at lookup. 10453 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 10454 ExprResult ObjectArg = 10455 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 10456 FoundDecl, Method); 10457 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 10458 return ExprError(); 10459 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take()); 10460 } 10461 10462 // Convert the rest of the arguments 10463 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 10464 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10465 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs, 10466 RParenLoc)) 10467 return ExprError(); 10468 10469 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs); 10470 10471 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall)) 10472 return ExprError(); 10473 10474 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 10475 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 10476 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 10477 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 10478 10479 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 10480 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 10481 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 10482 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 10483 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName(); 10484 10485 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 10486 } 10487 } 10488 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10489} 10490 10491/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 10492/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 10493/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 10494/// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 10495ExprResult 10496Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 10497 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 10498 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 10499 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10500 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 10501 return ExprError(); 10502 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj); 10503 10504 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 10505 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) 10506 return ExprError(); 10507 10508 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument"); 10509 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 10510 10511 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 10512 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 10513 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 10514 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 10515 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 10516 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 10517 // (E).operator(). 10518 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc); 10519 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 10520 10521 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 10522 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call) 10523 << Object.get()->getSourceRange())) 10524 return true; 10525 10526 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 10527 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 10528 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 10529 10530 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 10531 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 10532 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 10533 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 10534 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false); 10535 } 10536 10537 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 10538 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 10539 // declared in T of the form 10540 // 10541 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 10542 // 10543 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 10544 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 10545 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 10546 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 10547 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 10548 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 10549 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 10550 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 10551 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 10552 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 10553 // within T by another intervening declaration. 10554 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 10555 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 10556 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 10557 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 10558 NamedDecl *D = *I; 10559 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 10560 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 10561 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 10562 10563 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 10564 // surrogates. 10565 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 10566 continue; 10567 10568 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 10569 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 10570 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 10571 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 10572 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 10573 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 10574 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 10575 10576 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10577 { 10578 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 10579 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 10580 CandidateSet); 10581 } 10582 } 10583 } 10584 10585 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10586 10587 // Perform overload resolution. 10588 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10589 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10590 Best)) { 10591 case OR_Success: 10592 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 10593 // below. 10594 break; 10595 10596 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10597 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 10598 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 10599 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 10600 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10601 else 10602 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10603 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 10604 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10605 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10606 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10607 break; 10608 10609 case OR_Ambiguous: 10610 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10611 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 10612 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10613 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 10614 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10615 break; 10616 10617 case OR_Deleted: 10618 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10619 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 10620 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10621 << Object.get()->getType() 10622 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10623 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10624 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10625 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10626 break; 10627 } 10628 10629 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 10630 return true; 10631 10632 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10633 10634 if (Best->Function == 0) { 10635 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 10636 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 10637 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 10638 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 10639 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 10640 10641 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl); 10642 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc); 10643 10644 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 10645 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 10646 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job. 10647 10648 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 10649 // and then call it. 10650 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 10651 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 10652 if (Call.isInvalid()) 10653 return ExprError(); 10654 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 10655 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(), 10656 CK_UserDefinedConversion, 10657 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue)); 10658 10659 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), 10660 RParenLoc); 10661 } 10662 10663 MarkFunctionReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function); 10664 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl); 10665 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc); 10666 10667 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 10668 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 10669 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 10670 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10671 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 10672 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10673 10674 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 10675 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs; 10676 10677 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the 10678 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the 10679 // list). 10680 Expr **MethodArgs; 10681 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) { 10682 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto; 10683 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1]; 10684 } else { 10685 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1]; 10686 } 10687 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 10688 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 10689 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx]; 10690 10691 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 10692 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 10693 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 10694 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, 10695 HadMultipleCandidates, 10696 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 10697 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 10698 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 10699 return true; 10700 10701 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly 10702 // owned. 10703 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType(); 10704 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10705 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10706 10707 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 10708 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(), 10709 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1, 10710 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc); 10711 delete [] MethodArgs; 10712 10713 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, 10714 Method)) 10715 return true; 10716 10717 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more 10718 // slots in the call for them. 10719 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) 10720 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1); 10721 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) 10722 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto; 10723 10724 bool IsError = false; 10725 10726 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 10727 ExprResult ObjRes = 10728 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0, 10729 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 10730 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 10731 IsError = true; 10732 else 10733 Object = move(ObjRes); 10734 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take()); 10735 10736 // Check the argument types. 10737 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) { 10738 Expr *Arg; 10739 if (i < NumArgs) { 10740 Arg = Args[i]; 10741 10742 // Pass the argument. 10743 10744 ExprResult InputInit 10745 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 10746 Context, 10747 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 10748 SourceLocation(), Arg); 10749 10750 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 10751 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>(); 10752 } else { 10753 ExprResult DefArg 10754 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 10755 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 10756 IsError = true; 10757 break; 10758 } 10759 10760 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>(); 10761 } 10762 10763 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 10764 } 10765 10766 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 10767 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 10768 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 10769 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) { 10770 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0); 10771 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 10772 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take()); 10773 } 10774 } 10775 10776 if (IsError) return true; 10777 10778 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs); 10779 10780 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall)) 10781 return true; 10782 10783 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10784} 10785 10786/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 10787/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 10788/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 10789ExprResult 10790Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 10791 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 10792 "left-hand side must have class type"); 10793 10794 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 10795 return ExprError(); 10796 10797 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 10798 10799 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 10800 // 10801 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 10802 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 10803 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 10804 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 10805 DeclarationName OpName = 10806 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 10807 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc); 10808 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 10809 10810 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 10811 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag) 10812 << Base->getSourceRange())) 10813 return ExprError(); 10814 10815 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 10816 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl()); 10817 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 10818 10819 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 10820 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 10821 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 10822 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 10823 } 10824 10825 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10826 10827 // Perform overload resolution. 10828 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10829 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 10830 case OR_Success: 10831 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 10832 break; 10833 10834 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10835 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 10836 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 10837 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 10838 else 10839 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 10840 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 10841 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 10842 return ExprError(); 10843 10844 case OR_Ambiguous: 10845 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 10846 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 10847 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base); 10848 return ExprError(); 10849 10850 case OR_Deleted: 10851 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 10852 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10853 << "->" 10854 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10855 << Base->getSourceRange(); 10856 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 10857 return ExprError(); 10858 } 10859 10860 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function); 10861 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl); 10862 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 10863 10864 // Convert the object parameter. 10865 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10866 ExprResult BaseResult = 10867 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0, 10868 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 10869 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 10870 return ExprError(); 10871 Base = BaseResult.take(); 10872 10873 // Build the operator call. 10874 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, 10875 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 10876 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 10877 return ExprError(); 10878 10879 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType(); 10880 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10881 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10882 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 10883 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(), 10884 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 10885 10886 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 10887 Method)) 10888 return ExprError(); 10889 10890 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10891} 10892 10893/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 10894/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 10895ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 10896 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 10897 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 10898 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 10899 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 10900 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 10901 10902 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc); 10903 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true, 10904 TemplateArgs); 10905 10906 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10907 10908 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 10909 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 10910 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10911 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 10912 case OR_Success: 10913 case OR_Deleted: 10914 break; 10915 10916 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10917 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 10918 << R.getLookupName(); 10919 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 10920 return ExprError(); 10921 10922 case OR_Ambiguous: 10923 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName(); 10924 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 10925 return ExprError(); 10926 } 10927 10928 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 10929 MarkFunctionReferenced(UDSuffixLoc, FD); 10930 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UDSuffixLoc); 10931 10932 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, HadMultipleCandidates, 10933 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 10934 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 10935 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 10936 return true; 10937 10938 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 10939 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 10940 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 10941 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 10942 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 10943 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 10944 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 10945 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 10946 return true; 10947 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take(); 10948 } 10949 10950 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType(); 10951 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10952 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10953 10954 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = 10955 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(), ConvArgs, Args.size(), 10956 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc); 10957 10958 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 10959 return ExprError(); 10960 10961 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL)) 10962 return ExprError(); 10963 10964 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL); 10965} 10966 10967/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 10968/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 10969/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 10970/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 10971/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 10972Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 10973 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 10974 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 10975 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 10976 Found, Fn); 10977 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 10978 return PE; 10979 10980 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 10981 } 10982 10983 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 10984 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 10985 Found, Fn); 10986 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 10987 SubExpr->getType()) && 10988 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 10989 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 10990 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 10991 return ICE; 10992 10993 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 10994 ICE->getCastKind(), 10995 SubExpr, 0, 10996 ICE->getValueKind()); 10997 } 10998 10999 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 11000 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 11001 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 11002 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 11003 if (Method->isStatic()) { 11004 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 11005 // from non-member functions. 11006 } else { 11007 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an 11008 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 11009 // or template. 11010 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 11011 Found, Fn); 11012 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 11013 return UnOp; 11014 11015 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 11016 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 11017 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 11018 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 11019 11020 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 11021 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 11022 // appropriate pointer to member type. 11023 QualType ClassType 11024 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 11025 QualType MemPtrType 11026 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 11027 11028 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 11029 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 11030 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 11031 } 11032 } 11033 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 11034 Found, Fn); 11035 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 11036 return UnOp; 11037 11038 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 11039 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 11040 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 11041 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 11042 } 11043 11044 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 11045 // FIXME: avoid copy. 11046 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 11047 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11048 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 11049 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 11050 } 11051 11052 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 11053 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), 11054 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 11055 Fn, 11056 ULE->getNameLoc(), 11057 Fn->getType(), 11058 VK_LValue, 11059 Found.getDecl(), 11060 TemplateArgs); 11061 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 11062 return DRE; 11063 } 11064 11065 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 11066 // FIXME: avoid copy. 11067 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 11068 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11069 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 11070 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 11071 } 11072 11073 Expr *Base; 11074 11075 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 11076 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 11077 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 11078 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 11079 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 11080 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 11081 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 11082 Fn, 11083 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 11084 Fn->getType(), 11085 VK_LValue, 11086 Found.getDecl(), 11087 TemplateArgs); 11088 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 11089 return DRE; 11090 } else { 11091 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 11092 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 11093 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 11094 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc); 11095 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, 11096 MemExpr->getBaseType(), 11097 /*isImplicit=*/true); 11098 } 11099 } else 11100 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 11101 11102 ExprValueKind valueKind; 11103 QualType type; 11104 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 11105 valueKind = VK_LValue; 11106 type = Fn->getType(); 11107 } else { 11108 valueKind = VK_RValue; 11109 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 11110 } 11111 11112 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base, 11113 MemExpr->isArrow(), 11114 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 11115 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 11116 Fn, 11117 Found, 11118 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 11119 TemplateArgs, 11120 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary); 11121 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 11122 return ME; 11123 } 11124 11125 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 11126} 11127 11128ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 11129 DeclAccessPair Found, 11130 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 11131 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn)); 11132} 11133 11134} // end namespace clang 11135